blob: 5f1b1cd140b64b073be328a825f8442ed332d8fa [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
666ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
668 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300669 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100670 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
671 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
672 information.
673
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100674ssl-server-verify [none|required]
675 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
676 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
677 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
678
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200679stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
680 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
681 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
682 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
683 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200684
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200685 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
686 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
687 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200688
689stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
690 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
691 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100692 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200693
694stats maxconn <connections>
695 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
696 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698uid <number>
699 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
700 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
701 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
702 one. See also "gid" and "user".
703
704ulimit-n <number>
705 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
706 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
707 option.
708
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100709unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
710 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
711
712 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
713 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
714 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
715 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
716 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
717 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
718 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
719 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
720 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
721 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723user <user name>
724 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
725 See also "uid" and "group".
726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200727node <name>
728 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
729
730 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
731 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
732 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
733 traffic.
734
735description <text>
736 Add a text that describes the instance.
737
738 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
739 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
740 "<" and ">" characters.
741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744-----------------------
745
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200746max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
747 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
748 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
749 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
750 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
751 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
752 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
753 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
754 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756maxconn <number>
757 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
758 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
759 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200760 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
761 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
762 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
763 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
764 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200766maxconnrate <number>
767 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
768 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
769 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
770 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
771 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
772 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
773 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
774 fairness.
775
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100776maxcomprate <number>
777 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300778 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100779 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
780 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
781 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
782 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
783 default value.
784
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100785maxcompcpuusage <number>
786 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
787 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
788 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
789 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
790 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
791 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
792 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
793 process down and from introducing high latencies.
794
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100795maxpipes <number>
796 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
797 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
798 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
799 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
800 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
801 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
802
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200803maxsessrate <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
805 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
806 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
807 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
808 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
809 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
810 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
811 fairness.
812
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200813maxsslconn <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
815 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
816 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
817 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
818 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
819 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
820 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
821
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200822maxsslrate <number>
823 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
824 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
825 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
826 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
827 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
828 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
829 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
830 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
831 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
832 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
833
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100834maxzlibmem <number>
835 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
836 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
837 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100838 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
839 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
840 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842noepoll
843 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
844 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100845 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846
847nokqueue
848 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
849 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
850 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
851
852nopoll
853 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
854 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100855 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100856 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100858nosplice
859 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
860 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
861 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100862 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100863 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
864 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
865 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
866 "option splice-response".
867
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300868nogetaddrinfo
869 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
870 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
871
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200872spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900873 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
874 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
875 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
876 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
877 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
878 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200879
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200880tune.bufsize <number>
881 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
882 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
883 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
884 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
885 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
886 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
887 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
888 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400889 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
890 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
891 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200892
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200893tune.chksize <number>
894 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
895 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
896 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
897 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
898 checks whenever possible.
899
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100900tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
901 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
902 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
903 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
904 this value. The default value is 1.
905
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100906tune.http.cookielen <number>
907 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
908 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
909 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
910 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
911 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
912 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
913 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
914 to change this value.
915
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200916tune.http.maxhdr <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
918 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
919 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
920 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
921 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
922 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
923 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
924 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
925 limit too high.
926
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100927tune.idletimer <timeout>
928 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
929 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
930 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
931 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
932 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
933 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
934 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
935 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
936 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
937
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100938tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100939 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
940 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
941 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
942 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
943 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
944 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
945 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
946 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
947 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
948 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100949
950tune.maxpollevents <number>
951 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
952 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
953 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
954 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
955 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
956
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200957tune.maxrewrite <number>
958 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
959 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
960 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
961 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
962 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
963 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
964 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
965 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
966 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
967 bufsize.
968
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200969tune.pipesize <number>
970 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
971 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
972 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
973 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
974 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
975 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
976
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100977tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
978tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
979 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
980 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
981 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
982 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
983 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
984 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
985 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
986
987tune.sndbuf.client <number>
988tune.sndbuf.server <number>
989 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
990 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
991 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
992 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
993 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
994 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
995 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
996 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
997 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
998 notifying haproxy again.
999
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001000tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001001 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1002 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1003 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001004 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001005 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1006 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1007 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1008 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1009 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001010 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1011 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001012
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001013tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1014 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1015 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1016 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1017 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1018 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1019 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1020
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001021tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1022 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001023 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001024 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1025 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1026 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1027 being used for too long.
1028
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001029tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1030 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1031 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1032 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1033 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1034 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1035 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1036 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1037 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1038 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1039 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001040 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1041 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001042
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001043tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1044 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1045 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1046 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1047 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1048 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1049 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1050 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1051 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1052
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001053tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1054 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001055 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001056 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1057 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1058 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1059
1060tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1061 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1062 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1063 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1064 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010663.3. Debugging
1067--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069debug
1070 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1071 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1072 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1073 system startup.
1074
1075quiet
1076 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1077 line argument "-q".
1078
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010803.4. Userlists
1081--------------
1082It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1083http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1084it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1085
1086userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001087 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1089
1090group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001091 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001092 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1093 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1094
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001095user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1096 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001097 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1098 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1100 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001101 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001102 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001103
1104
1105 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001106 userlist L1
1107 group G1 users tiger,scott
1108 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001110 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1111 user scott insecure-password elgato
1112 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001113
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L2
1115 group G1
1116 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
1122 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001124
11253.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001126----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1128haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1129pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1130identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1131or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1132Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1133known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1134the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1135process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1136during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1137tables.
1138
1139peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001140 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001141 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1142
1143peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1144 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1145 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1146 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1147 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1148 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1149 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1150
1151 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1152 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1153
1154 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1155 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1156 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1157 across all peers.
1158
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001159 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1160 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1161 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1162
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001163 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001164 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001165 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1166 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1167 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001168
1169 backend mybackend
1170 mode tcp
1171 balance roundrobin
1172 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1173 stick on src
1174
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001177
1178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001181
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001182Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1183 - defaults <name>
1184 - frontend <name>
1185 - backend <name>
1186 - listen <name>
1187
1188A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1189its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1190section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001191section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001192
1193A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1194connections.
1195
1196A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1197to forward incoming connections.
1198
1199A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1200parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001202All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1203'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1204case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1205
1206Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1207logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1208proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1209However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1210name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1211
1212Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1213and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001214bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1216modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1217arbitrary criteria.
1218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001219In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1220a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1221the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1222
1223 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1224 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1225 between responses and new requests.
1226
1227 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1228 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1229 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1230 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1231
1232 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1233 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1234 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1235
1236 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1237 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1238 client-facing connection remains open.
1239
1240 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1241 after the end of the response.
1242
1243The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1244frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1245following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1246weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1247
1248 Backend mode
1249
1250 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1251 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1252 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1253 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1254 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1255 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1256 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1257 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1258 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1265--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001267The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1268limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1269they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1270limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001272option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001273and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1274with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1275specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001277
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1279------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1280acl - X X X
1281appsession - - X X
1282backlog X X X -
1283balance X - X X
1284bind - X X -
1285bind-process X X X X
1286block - X X X
1287capture cookie - X X -
1288capture request header - X X -
1289capture response header - X X -
1290clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001291compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001292contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1293cookie X - X X
1294default-server X - X X
1295default_backend X X X -
1296description - X X X
1297disabled X X X X
1298dispatch - - X X
1299enabled X X X X
1300errorfile X X X X
1301errorloc X X X X
1302errorloc302 X X X X
1303-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1304errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001305force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306fullconn X - X X
1307grace X X X X
1308hash-type X - X X
1309http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001310http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001311http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001312http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001313http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001314http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001316ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001317log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001318max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319maxconn X X X -
1320mode X X X X
1321monitor fail - X X -
1322monitor-net X X X -
1323monitor-uri X X X -
1324option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1325option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1326option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1327option allbackups (*) X - X X
1328option checkcache (*) X - X X
1329option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1330option contstats (*) X X X -
1331option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1332option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1333option forceclose (*) X X X X
1334-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1335option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001336option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001337option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001338option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001339option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001340option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001341option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1342option httpchk X - X X
1343option httpclose (*) X X X X
1344option httplog X X X X
1345option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001346option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001347option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001348option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1350option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1351option logasap (*) X X X -
1352option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001353option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001354option nolinger (*) X X X X
1355option originalto X X X X
1356option persist (*) X - X X
1357option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001358option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001359option smtpchk X - X X
1360option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1361option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1362option splice-request (*) X X X X
1363option splice-response (*) X X X X
1364option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1365option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1366-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001367option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1369option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1370option tcpka X X X X
1371option tcplog X X X X
1372option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001373external-check command X - X X
1374external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1376rate-limit sessions X X X -
1377redirect - X X X
1378redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1379redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1380reqadd - X X X
1381reqallow - X X X
1382reqdel - X X X
1383reqdeny - X X X
1384reqiallow - X X X
1385reqidel - X X X
1386reqideny - X X X
1387reqipass - X X X
1388reqirep - X X X
1389reqisetbe - X X X
1390reqitarpit - X X X
1391reqpass - X X X
1392reqrep - X X X
1393-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1394reqsetbe - X X X
1395reqtarpit - X X X
1396retries X - X X
1397rspadd - X X X
1398rspdel - X X X
1399rspdeny - X X X
1400rspidel - X X X
1401rspideny - X X X
1402rspirep - X X X
1403rsprep - X X X
1404server - - X X
1405source X - X X
1406srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001407stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001408stats auth X - X X
1409stats enable X - X X
1410stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001411stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412stats realm X - X X
1413stats refresh X - X X
1414stats scope X - X X
1415stats show-desc X - X X
1416stats show-legends X - X X
1417stats show-node X - X X
1418stats uri X - X X
1419-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1420stick match - - X X
1421stick on - - X X
1422stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001423stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001424stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001425tcp-check connect - - X X
1426tcp-check expect - - X X
1427tcp-check send - - X X
1428tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001429tcp-request connection - X X -
1430tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001431tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001432tcp-response content - - X X
1433tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434timeout check X - X X
1435timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001436timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001437timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1438timeout connect X - X X
1439timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1440timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1441timeout http-request X X X X
1442timeout queue X - X X
1443timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001444timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001445timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001447timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001448transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001449unique-id-format X X X -
1450unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001452use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1454 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1458---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
1460This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1461
1462
1463acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1464 Declare or complete an access list.
1465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1466 no | yes | yes | yes
1467 Example:
1468 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1469 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1470 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
1474
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1476 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1479 no | no | yes | yes
1480 Arguments :
1481 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1482 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1483
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001484 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485 checked in each cookie value.
1486
1487 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1488 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1489 milliseconds.
1490
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001491 request-learn
1492 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1493 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1494 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1495 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1496 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1497 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1498
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1500 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1501 data following this prefix.
1502
1503 Example :
1504 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1505
1506 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1507 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1508
1509 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1510 2 modes are currently supported :
1511 - path-parameters :
1512 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1513 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1514 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1515 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1516 - query-string :
1517 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1518 query string.
1519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1521 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1522 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1523 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001524 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1525 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1526 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1528 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1529
1530 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001532 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1533 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1534 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536 Example :
1537 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1538
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001539 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1540 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
1542
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001543backlog <conns>
1544 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1546 yes | yes | yes | no
1547 Arguments :
1548 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1549 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001550 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001551
1552 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1553 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1554 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1555 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1556 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1557 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1558 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1559 backlog parameter.
1560
1561 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1562 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1563 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1564
1565 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1566
1567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001569balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1572 yes | no | yes | yes
1573 Arguments :
1574 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1575 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1576 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1577 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1578
1579 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1580 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1581 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1582 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001583 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001584 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001585 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1586 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1587 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1588 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1589 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1590 it, so that you don't worry.
1591
1592 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1593 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1594 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1595 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1596 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1597 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1598 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1599 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001601 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1602 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1603 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1604 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1605 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1606 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1607 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1608 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1609
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001610 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001611 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001612 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1613 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001614 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001615 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1616 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1617 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1618 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1619 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1621 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1622 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1623 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1624 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1625 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1628 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1629 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1630 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1631 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1632 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1633 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1634 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001635 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001637 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1638 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1639 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001640
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001641 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1642 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1643 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1644 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1645 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1646 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1647 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1648 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1649 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1652 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001653
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001654 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001655 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1656 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1657 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1658 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1659 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1660 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1661 URIs start with a leading "/".
1662
1663 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1664 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1665 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1666 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001669 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1670
1671 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001672 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1673 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001674 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1675 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1676 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1677 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001679 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1680 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001681
1682 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1683 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1684 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1685 server will receive the request.
1686
1687 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1688 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1689 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1690 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1691 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001692 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1693 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1694 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001696 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1697 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1698 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1699 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1700 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001702 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001703 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1704 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1705 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1706
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001707 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1708 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1709 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1710
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001711 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001712 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001713 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1714 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1715 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1716 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1717 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1718 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001719 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001720 used instead.
1721
1722 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1723 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1724 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1725 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1726
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001727 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1728 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1729 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1730
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001731 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001734 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1735 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001736
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001737 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1738 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1739 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740
1741 Examples :
1742 balance roundrobin
1743 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001744 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001745 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1746 balance hdr(host)
1747 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001748
1749 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1750 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001752 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001753 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1754 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1755 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1756 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1757
1758 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1759 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1760 defaults to 16 kB.
1761
1762 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1763 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1764
1765 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1766 Round Robin.
1767
1768 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1769 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1770 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1771 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1772
1773 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1774
1775 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001776 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001777 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1778 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1779 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001781 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1782 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783
1784
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001785bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1786bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1789 no | yes | yes | no
1790 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001791 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1792 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1793 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1794 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001795 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001796 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1797 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1798 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1799 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1800 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1801 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1802 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001803 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1804 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1805 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1806 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1807 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1808 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1809 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001810 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1811 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1812 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001813 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1814 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1815 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1816 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001817
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001818 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1819 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1821 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1822 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001823 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1824 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1825 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1826 the range.
1827
1828 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1829 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1830 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1831 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1832 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1833 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1834 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001835 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001836 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001838 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1839 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1840 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1841 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1842 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1843 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1844 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1845 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1846
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001847 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1848 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1849 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1850 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001852 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1853 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1854 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1855 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1856 in a frontend.
1857
1858 Example :
1859 listen http_proxy
1860 bind :80,:443
1861 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001862 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001864 listen http_https_proxy
1865 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001866 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001867
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001868 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1869 bind ipv6@:80
1870 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1871 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1872
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001873 listen external_bind_app1
1874 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1875
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001877 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
1879
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001880bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001881 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1883 yes | yes | yes | yes
1884 Arguments :
1885 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1886 may be used to override a default value.
1887
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001888 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001889 option may be combined with other numbers.
1890
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001891 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001892 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1893 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1894 missing from all processes.
1895
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001896 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001898 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1899 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1900 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1901 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001902
1903 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1904 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1905 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1906 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1907 and 'even' instances.
1908
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001909 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1910 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1911 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1912 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001913
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001914 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1915 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1916
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001917 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1918 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1919
1920 Example :
1921 listen app_ip1
1922 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001923 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001924
1925 listen app_ip2
1926 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001927 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001928
1929 listen management
1930 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001931 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001932
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001933 listen management
1934 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1935 bind-process 1-4
1936
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001937 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001938
1939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001940block { if | unless } <condition>
1941 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 no | yes | yes | yes
1944
1945 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1946 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001947 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001948 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1950 "block" statements per instance.
1951
1952 Example:
1953 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1954 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1955 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1956 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001958 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960
1961capture cookie <name> len <length>
1962 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 no | yes | yes | no
1965 Arguments :
1966 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1967 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1968 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1969 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1970 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1971
1972 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1973 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1974 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1975 right if it exceeds <length>.
1976
1977 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1978 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1979 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1980 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1981
1982 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1983 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1984 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1985
1986 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1987 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1988 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001989 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1990 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1991 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992
1993 Example:
1994 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1995
1996 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001997 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998
1999
2000capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002001 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2003 no | yes | yes | no
2004 Arguments :
2005 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002006 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2008 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2009 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2010
2011 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2012 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2013 it exceeds <length>.
2014
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002015 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2017 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002018 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2019 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2020 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2021 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002022 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002023 environments to find where the request came from.
2024
2025 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2026 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2027 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2028 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002030 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2031 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2032 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2033 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2034 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035
2036 Example:
2037 capture request header Host len 15
2038 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2039 capture request header Referrer len 15
2040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002041 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 about logging.
2043
2044
2045capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002046 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2048 no | yes | yes | no
2049 Arguments :
2050 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002051 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2053 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2054 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2055
2056 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2057 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2058 it exceeds <length>.
2059
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002060 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2062 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2063 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002064 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2065 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2066 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2067 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002068
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002069 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2070 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2071 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2072 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2073 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
2075 Example:
2076 capture response header Content-length len 9
2077 capture response header Location len 15
2078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002079 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080 about logging.
2081
2082
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002083clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2086 yes | yes | yes | no
2087 Arguments :
2088 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2089 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2090 as explained at the top of this document.
2091
2092 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2093 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2094 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2095 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2096 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2097 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2098 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2099 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002100 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2102 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2103
2104 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2105 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2106 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2107 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2108 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2109 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2110
2111 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2112 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2113
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002114 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2115 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002117compression algo <algorithm> ...
2118compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002119compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002120 Enable HTTP compression.
2121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2122 yes | yes | yes | yes
2123 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002124 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2125 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2126 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2127
2128 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002129 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002130 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2131 data.
2132
2133 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2134 support for zlib was built in.
2135
2136 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2137 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2138 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2139 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2140 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2141 in.
2142
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002143 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002144 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002145 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2146 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2147 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2148 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2149 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002150
2151 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2152 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2153 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2154 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2155 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002156 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2157 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2158 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2159 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2160 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002161 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2162 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002163
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002164 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002165 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2166 "Accept-Encoding" header
2167 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002168 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002169 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2170 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002171 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2172 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2173 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2174 "multipart"
2175 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2176 header
2177 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2178 and later
2179 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2180 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002181
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002182 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2183 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002184
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002185 Examples :
2186 compression algo gzip
2187 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002188
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002189contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2192 yes | no | yes | yes
2193 Arguments :
2194 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2195 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2196 as explained at the top of this document.
2197
2198 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002199 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002200 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002201 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2202 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2203 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2204 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2205
2206 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2207 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2208 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2209 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2210 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2211 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2212
2213 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2214 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2215 instead.
2216
2217 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2218 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2219
2220
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002221cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002222 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2223 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2226 yes | no | yes | yes
2227 Arguments :
2228 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2229 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2230 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2231 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2232 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2233 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2234 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2235 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2236 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2237
2238 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2239 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2240 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2241 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2242 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2243 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2244 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2245 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2246 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2247 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2248 "insert" and "prefix".
2249
2250 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002251 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002252
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002253 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002254 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2255 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2256 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2257 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2258 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2259 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2260 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2261 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2262 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2263 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264
2265 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2266 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2267 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2268 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2269 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2270 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2271 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2272 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2273 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2274 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002275 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2276 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2277 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002279 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2280 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2281 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002282 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2283 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2284 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2285 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002286 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2287 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2288 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002289
2290 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2291 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2292 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2293 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2294 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2295 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2296 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2297 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2298 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2299
2300 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2301 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2302 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2303 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2304 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2305 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2306 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2307 persistence cookie in the cache.
2308 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2309
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002310 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2311 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2312 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2313 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2314 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2315 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2316 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2317 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2318 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2319 they logout.
2320
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002321 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2322 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2323 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2324 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2325
2326 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2327 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2328 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2329 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2330 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2331 this attribute.
2332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002333 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002334 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002335 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2336 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2337 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2338 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2339 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2340 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002341
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002342 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2343 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2344 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2345 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2346 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2347 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2348 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2349 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2350 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2351 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2352 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2353 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2354 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2355 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2356 the site.
2357
2358 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2359 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2360 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2361 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2362 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2363 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2364 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2365 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2366 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2367 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2368 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2369 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2370 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2371 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2372 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2373 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2376 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2377 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2378 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380 Examples :
2381 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2382 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2383 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002384 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002386 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002387 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002390default-server [param*]
2391 Change default options for a server in a backend
2392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2393 yes | no | yes | yes
2394 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002395 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2396 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2397 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2398 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002399
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002400 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002401 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2402
2403 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002406default_backend <backend>
2407 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2409 yes | yes | yes | no
2410 Arguments :
2411 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2412
2413 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2414 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2415 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2416 will catch all undetermined requests.
2417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418 Example :
2419
2420 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2421 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2422 default_backend dynamic
2423
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002424 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002426
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002427description <string>
2428 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2430 no | yes | yes | yes
2431 Arguments : string
2432
2433 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2434 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2435 it describes.
2436 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2437
2438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439disabled
2440 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2442 yes | yes | yes | yes
2443 Arguments : none
2444
2445 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2446 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2447 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2448 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2449 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2450 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2451 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2452
2453 See also : "enabled"
2454
2455
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002456dispatch <address>:<port>
2457 Set a default server address
2458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2459 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002460 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002461
2462 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2463 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2464 during start-up.
2465
2466 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2467 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2468 possible with normal servers.
2469
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002470 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002471 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2472 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2473 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2474 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2475
2476 See also : "server"
2477
2478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479enabled
2480 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2482 yes | yes | yes | yes
2483 Arguments : none
2484
2485 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2486 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2487
2488 See also : "disabled"
2489
2490
2491errorfile <code> <file>
2492 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2494 yes | yes | yes | yes
2495 Arguments :
2496 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002497 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498
2499 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002500 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002501 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002502 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2503 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504
2505 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2506 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2507 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2508
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002509 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2512 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2513 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2514 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2515
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002516 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2517 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2518 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2519 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2520 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2521 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2524 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2525 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002526 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2528
2529 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2530
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002531 Example :
2532 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002533 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002534 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2535 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2536
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002537
2538errorloc <code> <url>
2539errorloc302 <code> <url>
2540 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2542 yes | yes | yes | yes
2543 Arguments :
2544 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002545 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002546
2547 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2548 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2549 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2550 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2551 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2552
2553 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2554 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2555 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2556
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002557 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002559 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2560 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2561 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2562 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2563 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2564 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2565 request.
2566
2567 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2568
2569
2570errorloc303 <code> <url>
2571 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2573 yes | yes | yes | yes
2574 Arguments :
2575 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2576 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2577
2578 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2579 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2580 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2581 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2582 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2583
2584 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2585 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2586 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2587
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002588 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2591 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2592 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2593 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002594 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002595
2596 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2597
2598
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002599force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2600 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2602 no | yes | yes | yes
2603
2604 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2605 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2606 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2607 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2608 marked down for maintenance operations.
2609
2610 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2611 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2612 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2613 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2614 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2615 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2616 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2617 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2618 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2619
2620 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2621 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2622 is used.
2623
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002624 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002625 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002626
2627
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002628fullconn <conns>
2629 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2631 yes | no | yes | yes
2632 Arguments :
2633 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2634 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2635
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002636 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002637 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002638 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002639 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2640 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2641 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2642 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2643 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002644 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002645
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002646 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2647 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002648 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2649 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2650 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002651
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002652 Example :
2653 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2654 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2655 # connections.
2656 backend dynamic
2657 fullconn 10000
2658 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2659 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2660
2661 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2662
2663
2664grace <time>
2665 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002667 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002668 Arguments :
2669 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2670 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2671 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2672
2673 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2674 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002675 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002676 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2677
2678 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2679 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2680 simplify it.
2681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002683hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002684 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2686 yes | no | yes | yes
2687 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002688 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2689 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002690
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002691 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2692 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2693 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2694 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2695 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2696 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2697 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2698 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2699 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2700 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002701
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002702 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2703 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2704 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2705 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2706 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2707 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2708 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2709 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2710 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2711 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2712 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2713 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2714 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002715 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2716 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002717
2718 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2719
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002720 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002721 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2722 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2723 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002724 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2725 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2726 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002727
2728 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2729 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002730 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2731 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2732 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2733 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2734
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002735 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2736 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2737 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2738 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2739 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2740 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2741 parameter.
2742
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002743 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2744
2745 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2746 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2747 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2748 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2749 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2750 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2751 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2752 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2753 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2754 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2755 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2756 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002757
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002758 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2759 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2760 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002761
2762 See also : "balance", "server"
2763
2764
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765http-check disable-on-404
2766 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002768 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769 Arguments : none
2770
2771 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2772 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2773 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2774 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2775 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2776 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2777 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2778 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002779 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2780 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2781 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2782
2783 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2784
2785
2786http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002787 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002789 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002790 Arguments :
2791 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2792 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002793 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002794 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2795 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2796 details on the supported keywords.
2797
2798 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2799 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2800 with the usual backslash ('\').
2801
2802 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2803 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2804 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2805 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2806 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2807
2808 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002809 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002810 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2811 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2812 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2813
2814 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002815 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002816 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2817 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2818 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2819 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2820
2821 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002822 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002823 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2824 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2825 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2826 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2827 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2828 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2829 trace).
2830
2831 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2834 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2835 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2836 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2837 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2838 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2839
2840 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2841 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2842 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2843 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2844 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2845 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2846 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2847 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2848
2849 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2850 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2851
2852 Examples :
2853 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002854 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002855
2856 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002857 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002858
2859 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002860 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002861
2862 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002863 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002865 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002866
2867
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002868http-check send-state
2869 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 yes | no | yes | yes
2872 Arguments : none
2873
2874 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2875 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2876 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2877 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2878 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2879
2880 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2881 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2882 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2883 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2884 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2885 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2886 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2887 checked in multiple backends.
2888
2889 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2890 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2891
2892 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2893 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2894 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2895 one fails.
2896
2897 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2898 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2899 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2900
2901 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2902 server's queue.
2903
2904 Example of a header received by the application server :
2905 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2906 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2907
2908 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2909
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002910http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002911 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002912 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002913 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2914 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002915 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2916 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2917 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2918 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2919 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2920 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002921 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2923
2924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2925 no | yes | yes | yes
2926
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002927 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2928 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2929 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2930 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2931 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002932
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002933 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2934 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2935 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2936
2937 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2938 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2939 are evaluated.
2940
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002941 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2942 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2943 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2944 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2945 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2946 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2947 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2948 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2949 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002950 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002951 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2952
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002953 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2954 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2955 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2956 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2957 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2958
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002959 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2960 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2961 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002962 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2963 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002964
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002965 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2966 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2967 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2968 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2969 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2970 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2971 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2972 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2973
2974 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2975 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2976 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2977 external users.
2978
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002979 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2980 <name>.
2981
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002982 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2983 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2984 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2985 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2986 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2987 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2988 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2989 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2990
2991 Example:
2992
2993 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2994
2995 applied to:
2996
2997 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2998
2999 outputs:
3000
3001 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3002
3003 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3004
3005 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3006 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3007 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3008 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3009 header.
3010
3011 Example:
3012
3013 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3014
3015 applied to:
3016
3017 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3018
3019 outputs:
3020
3021 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3022
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003023 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3024 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3025 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3026 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3027 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3028 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3029 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3030 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3031
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003032 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3033 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3034 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3035 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3036 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3037 another equipment.
3038
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003039 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3040 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3041 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3042 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3043 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3044 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3045 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3046 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3047
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003048 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3049 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3050 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3051 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3052 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3053 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3054 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3055 admin privileges.
3056
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003057 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3058 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3059 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3060 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3061 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3062 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3063 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3064 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3065
3066 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3067 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3068 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3069 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3070 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3071 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3072
3073 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3074 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3075 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3076 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3077 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3078 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3079
3080 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3081 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3082 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3083 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3084 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3085 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3086 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3087 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3088 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3089
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003090 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3091
3092 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3093 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3094 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3095 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003096
3097 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003098 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3099 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3100 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003101
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003102 http-request allow if nagios
3103 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3104 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3105 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003106
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003107 Example:
3108 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003109 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003110
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003111 Example:
3112 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3113 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3114 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3115 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3116 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3117 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3118 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3119 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3120 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3121
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003122 Example:
3123 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3124 acl add path /addacl
3125 acl del path /delacl
3126
3127 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3128
3129 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3130 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3131
3132 Example:
3133 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3134 acl setmap path /setmap
3135 acl delmap path /delmap
3136
3137 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3138
3139 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3140 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3141
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003142 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3143 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003144
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003145http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003146 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003147 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3148 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003149 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3150 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3151 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3152 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3153 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3154 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003155 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003156 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3157
3158 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3159 no | yes | yes | yes
3160
3161 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3162 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3163 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3164 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3165 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3166 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3167
3168 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3169 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3170 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3171 current section.
3172
3173 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3174 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3175 rules are evaluated.
3176
3177 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3178 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3179 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3180 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3181 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3182 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3183 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3184
3185 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3186 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3187 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3188 external users.
3189
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003190 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3191 <name>.
3192
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003193 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3194 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3195 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3196 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3197 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3198 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3199 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3200 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3201
3202 Example:
3203
3204 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3205
3206 applied to:
3207
3208 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3209
3210 outputs:
3211
3212 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3213
3214 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3215
3216 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3217 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3218 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3219 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3220 header.
3221
3222 Example:
3223
3224 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3225
3226 applied to:
3227
3228 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3229
3230 outputs:
3231
3232 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3233
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003234 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3235 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3236 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3237 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3238 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3239 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3240 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3241 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3242
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003243 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3244 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3245 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3246 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3247 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3248 another equipment.
3249
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003250 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3251 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3252 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3253 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3254 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3255 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3256 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3257 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3258
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003259 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3260 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3261 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3262 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3263 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3264 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3265 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3266 admin privileges.
3267
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003268 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3269 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3270 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3271 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3272 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3273 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3274 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3275 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3276
3277 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3278 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3279 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3280 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3281 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3282 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3283
3284 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3285 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3286 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3287 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3288 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3289 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3290
3291 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3292 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3293 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3294 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3295 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3296 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3297 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3298 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3299 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3300
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003301 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3302
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003303 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003304 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3305 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3306 rules.
3307
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003308 Example:
3309 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3310
3311 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3312
3313 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3314 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3315
3316 Example:
3317 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3318
3319 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3320
3321 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3322 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3323
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003324 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3325 ACL usage.
3326
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003327
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003328http-send-name-header [<header>]
3329 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3330
3331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | no | yes | yes
3333
3334 Arguments :
3335
3336 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3337
3338 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3339 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3340 is added with the header string proved.
3341
3342 See also : "server"
3343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003344id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003345 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 no | yes | yes | yes
3348 Arguments : none
3349
3350 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3351 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3352 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003353
3354
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003355ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3356 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3358 no | yes | yes | yes
3359
3360 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3361 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3362 and running).
3363
3364 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3365 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3366 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003367 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003368 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3369
3370 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3371 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3372
3373 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3374 "unless" condition is met.
3375
3376 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3377
3378
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003379log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003380log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003381no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003382 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003385
3386 Prefix :
3387 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3388 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3389 prefix does not allow arguments.
3390
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003391 Arguments :
3392 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3393 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3394 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3395 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3396 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3397 parameter.
3398
3399 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3400 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3401
3402 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3403 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3404 standard syslog port).
3405
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003406 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3407 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3408 standard syslog port).
3409
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003410 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3411 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3412 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3413 appropriately writeable).
3414
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003415 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3416 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3417 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3418 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3419
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003420 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3421 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3422 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3423 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3424 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3425 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3426 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3427 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3428 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3429 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3430 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3431
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003432 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3433
3434 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3435 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3436 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3437
3438 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3439 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3440 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003441 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3442 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3443 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3444 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3445 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003446
3447 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3448
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003449 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3450 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3451 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003452
3453 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3454 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3455 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3456 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3457
3458 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3459 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003460
3461 Example :
3462 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003463 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3464 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003465 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3466
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003467
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003468log-format <string>
3469 Allows you to custom a log line.
3470
3471 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3472
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003473
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003474max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3475 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3477 yes | no | yes | yes
3478
3479 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3480 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3481 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3482 servers.
3483
3484 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3485 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3486 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3487 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3488 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3489 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3490 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3491 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3492 picking a different server.
3493
3494 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3495 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3496 even if they have to be queued.
3497
3498 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3499 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3500
3501
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003502maxconn <conns>
3503 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3505 yes | yes | yes | no
3506 Arguments :
3507 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3508 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3509 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3510 closes.
3511
3512 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3513 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3514 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3515 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3516 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3517 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3518 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3519 properly tuned.
3520
3521 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3522 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3523 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3524
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003525 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3526
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003527 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3528
3529
3530mode { tcp|http|health }
3531 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3533 yes | yes | yes | yes
3534 Arguments :
3535 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3536 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3537 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3538 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3539
3540 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3541 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3542 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3543 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3544 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3545
3546 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003547 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3548 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3549 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3550 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3551 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3552 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3553 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003554
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003555 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3556 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3557 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003558
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003559 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560 defaults http_instances
3561 mode http
3562
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003563 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003566monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003567 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003570 Arguments :
3571 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3572 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003573 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3575 backend and its backup.
3576
3577 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3578 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3579 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3580 servers in a list of backends.
3581
3582 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3583 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3584 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3585 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3586 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3587 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3588 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003589 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3590 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591
3592 Example:
3593 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003594 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3596 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3597 monitor-uri /site_alive
3598 monitor fail if site_dead
3599
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003600 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003601
3602
3603monitor-net <source>
3604 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3606 yes | yes | yes | no
3607 Arguments :
3608 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3609 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3610 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3611 followed by a mask.
3612
3613 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3614 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003615 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3617
3618 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3619 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3620 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3621 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003622 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3623 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3624 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003626 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3627 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3628 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3629 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3630 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3631 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003632
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003633 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3634 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003635
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003636 Example :
3637 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3638 frontend www
3639 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3640
3641 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3642
3643
3644monitor-uri <uri>
3645 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3647 yes | yes | yes | no
3648 Arguments :
3649 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3650 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3651
3652 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3653 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3654 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3655 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3656 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3657 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3658 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3659 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3660
3661 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3662 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3663 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3664 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3665 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3666 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3667
3668 Example :
3669 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3670 frontend www
3671 mode http
3672 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3673
3674 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003677option abortonclose
3678no option abortonclose
3679 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3681 yes | no | yes | yes
3682 Arguments : none
3683
3684 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3685 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3686 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3687 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003688 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003689 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3690 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3691 encountered while delivering the response.
3692
3693 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3694 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3695 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3696 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3697 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3698 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003699 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003700 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003701 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003702 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3703 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3704 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3705
3706 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3707 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3708 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3709 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3710 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3711 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3712 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3713 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003714 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003715
3716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3718
3719 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3720
3721
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003722option accept-invalid-http-request
3723no option accept-invalid-http-request
3724 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3726 yes | yes | yes | no
3727 Arguments : none
3728
3729 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3730 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3731 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3732 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3733 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3734 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3735 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3736 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003737 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3738 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3739 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3740 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3741 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3742 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003743
3744 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3745 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3746 been confirmed.
3747
3748 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3749 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003750 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3751 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003752 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3753
3754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3756
3757 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3758 stats socket.
3759
3760
3761option accept-invalid-http-response
3762no option accept-invalid-http-response
3763 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | no | yes | yes
3766 Arguments : none
3767
3768 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3769 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3770 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3771 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3772 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3773 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3774 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3775 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3776 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3777
3778 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3779 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3780 been confirmed.
3781
3782 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3783 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3784 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3785 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3786
3787 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3788 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3789
3790 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3791 stats socket.
3792
3793
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003794option allbackups
3795no option allbackups
3796 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 yes | no | yes | yes
3799 Arguments : none
3800
3801 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3802 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3803 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3804 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3805 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3806 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3807 order between the backup servers anymore.
3808
3809 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3810 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3811
3812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3814
3815
3816option checkcache
3817no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003818 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3820 yes | no | yes | yes
3821 Arguments : none
3822
3823 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3824 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003825 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003826 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3827 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003828 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003829
3830 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003831 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003832 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003833 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3834 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003835 to the client are :
3836 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003837 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003838 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003839 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3840 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3841 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3842 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3843 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3844 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3845 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3846 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3847 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3848 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3849 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3850
3851 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003852 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003853 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003854 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003855 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3856
3857 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3858 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003859 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003860 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3861
3862 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3863 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3864
3865
3866option clitcpka
3867no option clitcpka
3868 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3870 yes | yes | yes | no
3871 Arguments : none
3872
3873 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3874 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3875 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3876 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3877
3878 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3879 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3880 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3881 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3882
3883 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3884 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3885 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3886 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3887 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3888
3889 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3890
3891 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3892 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3893 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3894
3895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3897
3898 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3899
3900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901option contstats
3902 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3904 yes | yes | yes | no
3905 Arguments : none
3906
3907 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3908 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3909 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3910 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3911 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3912 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3913 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3914
3915
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003916option dontlog-normal
3917no option dontlog-normal
3918 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | yes | yes | no
3921 Arguments : none
3922
3923 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3924 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3925 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3926 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3927 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3928 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3929 logged.
3930
3931 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3932 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3933 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003935 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003936 logging.
3937
3938
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003939option dontlognull
3940no option dontlognull
3941 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 yes | yes | yes | no
3944 Arguments : none
3945
3946 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3947 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3948 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3949 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3950 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3951 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3952 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3953
3954 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3955 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3956 would not be logged.
3957
3958 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3959 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003961 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003962
3963
3964option forceclose
3965no option forceclose
3966 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003968 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3972 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3973 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3974 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3975 global session times in the logs.
3976
3977 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003978 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003979 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003980
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003981 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3982 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3983 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3984
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003985 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3986 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003987
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003988 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3989 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3990
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003991 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003992
3993
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003994option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003995 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3997 yes | yes | yes | yes
3998 Arguments :
3999 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4000 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004001 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004002 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004003
4004 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4005 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4006 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4007 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4008 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4009 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4010 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004011 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4012 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4013 possible that the client has already brought one.
4014
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004015 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004016 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004017 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4018 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004019 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4020 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004021
4022 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4023 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4024 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4025 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4026 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4027 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4028 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4029
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004030 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4031 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4032 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4033 are under the control of the end-user.
4034
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004035 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004036 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4037 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004038 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4039 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4040 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004041
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004042 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004043 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4044 frontend www
4045 mode http
4046 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4047
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004048 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4049 backend www
4050 mode http
4051 option forwardfor header X-Client
4052
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004053 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004054 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004055
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004056
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004057option http-keep-alive
4058no option http-keep-alive
4059 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 yes | yes | yes | yes
4062 Arguments : none
4063
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004064 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4065 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4066 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4067 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4068 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4069 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4070 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4071
4072 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4073 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004074 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4075 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4076 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4077 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4078 situations where this option may be useful :
4079
4080 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4081 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4082
4083 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4084 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4085
4086 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4087 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4088 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4089 request.
4090
4091 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4092 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004093 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4094 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4095 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004096
4097 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4098 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4099
4100 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4101 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4102 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4103 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4104 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4105 not set.
4106
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004107 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4108 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004109 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004110 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004111
4112 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004113 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4114 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004115
4116
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004117option http-no-delay
4118no option http-no-delay
4119 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4121 yes | yes | yes | yes
4122 Arguments : none
4123
4124 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4125 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4126 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4127 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4128 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4129 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4130 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4131 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4132 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4133 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4134 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4135 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4136 affected.
4137
4138 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4139 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4140 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4141 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4142 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4143 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4144 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4145 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4146 latency environments.
4147
4148
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004149option http-pretend-keepalive
4150no option http-pretend-keepalive
4151 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4153 yes | yes | yes | yes
4154 Arguments : none
4155
4156 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4157 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4158 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4159 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4160 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4161 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4162 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4163 consider the response complete.
4164
4165 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4166 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4167 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4168 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4169 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4170 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4171
4172 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4173 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4174 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4175 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4176 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4177 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4178 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4179
4180 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4181 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004182 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004183 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4184 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004185
4186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4188
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004189 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4190 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004191
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004192
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004193option http-server-close
4194no option http-server-close
4195 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4197 yes | yes | yes | yes
4198 Arguments : none
4199
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004200 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4201 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4202 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4203 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4204 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4205 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4206 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4207 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4208 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4209 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4210 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4211 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4212 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4213 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4214 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4215 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004216
4217 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4218 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4219 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4220 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004221 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4222 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004223
4224 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4225 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004226 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4227 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004228 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4229 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004230
4231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4233
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004234 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004235 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4236 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004237
4238
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004239option http-tunnel
4240no option http-tunnel
4241 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4243 yes | yes | yes | yes
4244 Arguments : none
4245
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004246 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4247 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4248 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4249 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4250 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4251 "option http-tunnel".
4252
4253 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004254 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004255 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4256 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4257 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4258 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4259 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4260 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4261 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004262
4263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4265
4266 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4267 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4268 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4269
4270
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004271option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004272no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004273 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4275 yes | yes | yes | no
4276 Arguments : none
4277
4278 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4279 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4280 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4281 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4282 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4283 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4284 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4285
4286 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4287 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4288 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4289 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4290 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4291 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4292 request along its whole life.
4293
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004294 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4295 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4296 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4297 front of an existing proxy.
4298
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004299 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4300
4301 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4302 http-server-close".
4303
4304
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004305option httpchk
4306option httpchk <uri>
4307option httpchk <method> <uri>
4308option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4309 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | no | yes | yes
4312 Arguments :
4313 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4314 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4315 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4316 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4317 ones.
4318
4319 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4320 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4321 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4322
4323 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4324 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4325 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4326 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4327 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4328
4329 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4330 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4331 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4332 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4333 the lack of any response.
4334
4335 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4336
4337 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4338 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4339 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4340
4341 Examples :
4342 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4343 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4344 backend https_relay
4345 mode tcp
4346 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4347 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4348
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004349 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4350 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4351 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004352
4353
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004354option httpclose
4355no option httpclose
4356 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 yes | yes | yes | yes
4359 Arguments : none
4360
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004361 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4362 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4363 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4364 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004365 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004366 "option http-tunnel".
4367
4368 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4369 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4370 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4371 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4372 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4373 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4374 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4375 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004376
4377 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004378 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004379 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4380 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4381 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4382 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4383 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004384
4385 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4386 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004387 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4388 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004389 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4390 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004391
4392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4394
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004395 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4396 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004397
4398
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004399option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004400 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004403 Arguments :
4404 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4405 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4406 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4407 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4408 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004409
4410 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4411 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4412 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4413 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4414 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4415 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4416 ports.
4417
4418 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4419
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4422 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4423 by default.
4424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004425 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004426
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004427
4428option http_proxy
4429no option http_proxy
4430 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4432 yes | yes | yes | yes
4433 Arguments : none
4434
4435 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4436 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4437 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4438 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4439 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4440
4441 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4442 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4443 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4444 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004445 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004446 be analyzed.
4447
4448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4450
4451 Example :
4452 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4453 backend direct_forward
4454 option httpclose
4455 option http_proxy
4456
4457 See also : "option httpclose"
4458
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004459
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004460option independent-streams
4461no option independent-streams
4462 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4464 yes | yes | yes | yes
4465 Arguments : none
4466
4467 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4468 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4469 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4470 receive data or not.
4471
4472 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4473 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4474 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4475 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4476 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4477 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4478 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4479 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4480 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4481 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4482 socket buffers.
4483
4484 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4485 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4486 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4487 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4488 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4489
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004490 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004491 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4492 deprecated.
4493
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004494 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004495
4496
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004497option ldap-check
4498 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4500 yes | no | yes | yes
4501 Arguments : none
4502
4503 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4504 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4505 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4506 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4507
4508 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4509 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4510
4511 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4512 configure it.
4513
4514 Example :
4515 option ldap-check
4516
4517 See also : "option httpchk"
4518
4519
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004520option external-check
4521 Use external processes for server health checks
4522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | no | yes | yes
4524
4525 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4526 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4527 command".
4528
4529 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4530
4531 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4532
4533
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004534option log-health-checks
4535no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004536 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4538 yes | no | yes | yes
4539 Arguments : none
4540
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004541 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4542 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4543 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004544
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004545 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4546 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4547 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4548 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4549 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4550
4551 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4552 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004553
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004554 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4555 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4556 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004557
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004558
4559option log-separate-errors
4560no option log-separate-errors
4561 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4563 yes | yes | yes | no
4564 Arguments : none
4565
4566 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4567 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4568 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4569 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4570 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4571 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4572 provides very important information.
4573
4574 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4575 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4576 error logs.
4577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004578 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004579 logging.
4580
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004581
4582option logasap
4583no option logasap
4584 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 yes | yes | yes | no
4587 Arguments : none
4588
4589 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4590 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4591 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4592 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4593 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4594 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4595 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004596 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004597 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4598 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004600 Examples :
4601 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4602 mode http
4603 option httplog
4604 option logasap
4605 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4606
4607 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4608 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4609 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4610 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004612 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004613 logging.
4614
4615
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004616option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004617 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4619 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004620 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004621 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4622 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004623 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004624
4625 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4626 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4627 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4628 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4629 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4630 in the MySQL table, like this :
4631
4632 USE mysql;
4633 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4634 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4635
4636 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4637 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4638 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4639 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4640 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4641 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4642 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4643 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4644 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4645
4646 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4647 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004648
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004649 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004650
4651 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4652 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4653 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4654 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4655 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4656 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4657
4658 See also: "option httpchk"
4659
4660
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004661option nolinger
4662no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004663 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004666 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004667
4668 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4669 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4670 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4671 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4672 connections.
4673
4674 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4675 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4676 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4677 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4678 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4679 this too.
4680
4681 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4682 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4683 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4684
4685 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4686 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4687 for servers.
4688
4689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4691
4692
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004693option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4694 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | yes | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
4698 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4699 matching <network>
4700 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4701 header name.
4702
4703 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4704 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4705 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4706 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4707 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4708 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4709 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4710 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4711 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4712 possible that the client has already brought one.
4713
4714 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4715 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4716 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4717 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4718 header and requires different one.
4719
4720 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4721 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4722 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4723 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4724 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4725 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4726 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4727
4728 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4729 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4730 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4731 both are defined.
4732
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004733 Examples :
4734 # Original Destination address
4735 frontend www
4736 mode http
4737 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4738
4739 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4740 backend www
4741 mode http
4742 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4743
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004744 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4745 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004746
4747
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004748option persist
4749no option persist
4750 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004753 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004754
4755 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4756 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4757 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4758 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4759 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4760 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4761 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4762 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4763 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4764 redirected to another valid server.
4765
4766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4768
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004769 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004770
4771
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004772option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4773 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4775 yes | no | yes | yes
4776 Arguments :
4777 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4778 PostgreSQL server.
4779
4780 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4781 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4782 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4783 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4784
4785 See also: "option httpchk"
4786
4787
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004788option prefer-last-server
4789no option prefer-last-server
4790 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | no | yes | yes
4793 Arguments : none
4794
4795 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4796 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4797 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4798 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4799 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4800 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4801 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4802 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4803 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004804 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4805 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4806 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4807 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4808 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4809 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4810 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004811
4812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4814
4815 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4816
4817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004818option redispatch
4819no option redispatch
4820 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004823 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004824
4825 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4826 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4827 be able to access the service anymore.
4828
4829 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4830 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4831
4832 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4833 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4834 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004836 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4837 "redisp" keywords.
4838
4839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4841
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004842 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004843
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004844
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004845option redis-check
4846 Use redis health checks for server testing
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | no | yes | yes
4849 Arguments : none
4850
4851 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4852 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4853 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4854 find the "+PONG" response message.
4855
4856 Example :
4857 option redis-check
4858
4859 See also : "option httpchk"
4860
4861
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004862option smtpchk
4863option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4864 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004867 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004868 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4869 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4870 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4871
4872 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4873 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4874 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4875
4876 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4877 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4878 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4879 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4880 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4881 dead server.
4882
4883 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4884 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4885 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4886 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4887
4888 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4889 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4890 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4891 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4892 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4893
4894 Example :
4895 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4896
4897 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004900option socket-stats
4901no option socket-stats
4902
4903 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | no
4906
4907 Arguments : none
4908
4909
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004910option splice-auto
4911no option splice-auto
4912 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915 Arguments : none
4916
4917 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4918 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4919 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4920 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004921 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004922 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4923 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4924 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4925 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4926
4927 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4928 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4929 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4930 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4931 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4932 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4933 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4934 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4935 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4936 keyword.
4937
4938 Example :
4939 option splice-auto
4940
4941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4943
4944 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4945 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4946
4947
4948option splice-request
4949no option splice-request
4950 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | yes | yes | yes
4953 Arguments : none
4954
4955 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004956 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004957 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4958 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4959 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4960 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4961
4962 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4963
4964 Example :
4965 option splice-request
4966
4967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4969
4970 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4971 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4972
4973
4974option splice-response
4975no option splice-response
4976 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | yes
4979 Arguments : none
4980
4981 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004982 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004983 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4984 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4985 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4986 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4987
4988 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4989
4990 Example :
4991 option splice-response
4992
4993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4995
4996 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4997 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4998
4999
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005000option srvtcpka
5001no option srvtcpka
5002 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5004 yes | no | yes | yes
5005 Arguments : none
5006
5007 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5008 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5009 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5010 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5011
5012 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5013 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5014 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5015 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5016
5017 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5018 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5019 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5020 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5021 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5022
5023 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5024
5025 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5026 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5027 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5028
5029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5031
5032 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5033
5034
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005035option ssl-hello-chk
5036 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | no | yes | yes
5039 Arguments : none
5040
5041 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5042 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5043 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5044 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5045 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5046 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5047 hello message.
5048
5049 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5050 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5051 messages, which is appreciable.
5052
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005053 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5054 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5055 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005056
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005057 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5058
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005059
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005060option tcp-check
5061 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 yes | no | yes | yes
5064
5065 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5066 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5067
5068 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5069 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5070 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5071
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005072 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005073 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5074 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5075 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5076 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5077 only.
5078
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005079 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005080 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5081 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5082 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5083 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5084
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005085 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005086 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5087 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005088 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005089 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5090 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5091 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5092 the respective protocols.
5093 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5094 analysed.
5095
5096 Examples :
5097 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5098 option tcp-check
5099 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5100
5101 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5102 option tcp-check
5103 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5104
5105 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5106 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005107 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005108 option tcp-check
5109 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5110 tcp-check expect +PONG
5111 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5112 tcp-check expect string role:master
5113 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5114 tcp-check expect string +OK
5115
5116 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5117 (send many headers before analyzing)
5118 option tcp-check
5119 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5120 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5121 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5122 tcp-check send \r\n
5123 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5124
5125
5126 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5127
5128
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005129option tcp-smart-accept
5130no option tcp-smart-accept
5131 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 yes | yes | yes | no
5134 Arguments : none
5135
5136 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5137 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5138 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5139 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5140 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5141 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5142
5143 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5144 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5145 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5146 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5147
5148 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5149 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5150 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5151 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5152
5153 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5154 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5155 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5156
5157 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5158 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5159 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5160
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005161 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5162
5163
5164option tcp-smart-connect
5165no option tcp-smart-connect
5166 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5168 yes | no | yes | yes
5169 Arguments : none
5170
5171 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5172 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5173 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5174 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5175 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5176
5177 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5178 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5179 complex.
5180
5181 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5182 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5183 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5184
5185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5187
5188 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5189
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005190
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005191option tcpka
5192 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 yes | yes | yes | yes
5195 Arguments : none
5196
5197 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5198 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5199 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5200 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5201
5202 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5203 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5204 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5205 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5206
5207 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5208 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5209 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5210 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5211 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5212
5213 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5214
5215 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5216 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5217 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5218 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5219 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5220 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5221 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5222 backends.
5223
5224 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5225
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005226
5227option tcplog
5228 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5230 yes | yes | yes | yes
5231 Arguments : none
5232
5233 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5234 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5235 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5236 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5237 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5238 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5239 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5240 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5241
5242 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005244 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005245
5246
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005247option transparent
5248no option transparent
5249 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005251 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005252 Arguments : none
5253
5254 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5255 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5256 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5257 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5258 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5259 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5260 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5261 appropriate server.
5262
5263 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5264 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5265
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005266 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005267 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005268
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005269
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005270external-check command <command>
5271 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5273 yes | no | yes | yes
5274
5275 Arguments :
5276 <command> is the external command to run
5277
5278 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5279 command may be set using "external-check path".
5280
5281 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5282
5283 proxy_address proxy_port server_address server_port
5284
5285 The proxy_address and proxy_port are derived from the first listener
5286 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. It is an error for no such
5287 listeners to exist. In the case of a UNIX socket listener the
5288 proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the proxy_port will
5289 be the string "NOT_USED".
5290
5291 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5292 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5293 failed.
5294
5295 Example :
5296 external-check command /bin/true
5297
5298 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5299
5300
5301external-check path <path>
5302 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | no | yes | yes
5305
5306 Arguments :
5307 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5308
5309 The default path is "".
5310
5311 Example :
5312 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5313
5314 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5315 "external-check command"
5316
5317
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005318persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005319persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005320 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | no | yes | yes
5323 Arguments :
5324 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005325 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5326 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005327
5328 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5329 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5330 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5331 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5332 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5333 forwarded to this server.
5334
5335 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5336 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5337 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005338 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005339 a single "listen" section.
5340
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005341 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5342 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5343 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5344
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005345 Example :
5346 listen tse-farm
5347 bind :3389
5348 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5349 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5350 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5351 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5352 persist rdp-cookie
5353 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005354 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005355 balance rdp-cookie
5356 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5357 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5358
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005359 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5360 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005361
5362
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005363rate-limit sessions <rate>
5364 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 yes | yes | yes | no
5367 Arguments :
5368 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5369 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5370
5371 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5372 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5373 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5374 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5375 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5376 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5377
5378 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5379 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5380 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5381 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5382
5383 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5384 listen smtp
5385 mode tcp
5386 bind :25
5387 rate-limit sessions 10
5388 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5389
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005390 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5391 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5392 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005393
5394 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5395
5396
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005397redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5398redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5399redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005400 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 no | yes | yes | yes
5403
5404 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005405 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005406
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005407 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005408 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005409 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5410 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5411 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005412
5413 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5414 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5415 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5416 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5417 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005418 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5419 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5420 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5421 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005422
5423 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5424 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5425 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5426 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5427 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5428 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005429 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005430 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005431 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5432 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5433 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005434
5435 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005436 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5437 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5438 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5439 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5440 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5441 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5442 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5443 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005444
5445 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5446 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5447
5448 - "drop-query"
5449 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5450 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5451 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5452 with a location-type redirect.
5453
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005454 - "append-slash"
5455 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5456 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5457 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5458 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5459
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005460 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5461 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5462 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5463 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5464 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5465 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5466 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5467
5468 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5469 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5470 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5471 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5472 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5473 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5474 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005475
5476 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5477 acl clear dst_port 80
5478 acl secure dst_port 8080
5479 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005480 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005481 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005482 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5483
5484 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005485 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5486 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5487 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005488 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005489
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005490 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5491 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5492 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5493
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005494 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005495 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005496
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005497 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5498 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5499 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005501 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005502
5503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005504redisp (deprecated)
5505redispatch (deprecated)
5506 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5508 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005509 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005510
5511 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5512 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5513 be able to access the service anymore.
5514
5515 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5516 redistribute them to a working server.
5517
5518 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5519 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5520 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005522 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5523 "option redispatch" instead.
5524
5525 See also : "option redispatch"
5526
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005527
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005528reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005529 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 no | yes | yes | yes
5532 Arguments :
5533 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5534 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005535 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005536
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005537 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5538 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5539
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005540 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5541 the last header of an HTTP request.
5542
5543 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5544 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5545 responses.
5546
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005547 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5548 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5549 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5550
5551 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5552 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005553
5554
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005555reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5556reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005557 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5559 no | yes | yes | yes
5560 Arguments :
5561 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5562 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5563 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5564 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5565 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5566 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5567 ignores case.
5568
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005569 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5570 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5571
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005572 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5573 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5574 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5575 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005576 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005577
5578 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5579 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5580
5581 Example :
5582 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5583 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5584 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5585
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005586 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5587 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005588
5589
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005590reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5591reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005592 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 no | yes | yes | yes
5595 Arguments :
5596 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5597 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5598 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5599 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5600 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5601 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5602
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005603 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5604 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5605
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005606 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5607 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5608 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5609 next servers.
5610
5611 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5612 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5613 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5614
5615 Example :
5616 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5617 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5618 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5619
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005620 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5621 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005622
5623
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005624reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5625reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005626 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5628 no | yes | yes | yes
5629 Arguments :
5630 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5631 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5632 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5633 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5634 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5635 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5636 case.
5637
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005638 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5639 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5640
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005641 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5642 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5643 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5644 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005645 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005646
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005647 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005648 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005649 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005650
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005651 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5652 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5653
5654 Example :
5655 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5656 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5657 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5658
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005659 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5660 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005661
5662
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005663reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5664reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005665 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5667 no | yes | yes | yes
5668 Arguments :
5669 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5670 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5671 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5672 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5673 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5674 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5675 case.
5676
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005677 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5678 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5679
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005680 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5681 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5682 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5683 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5684
5685 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5686 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5687
5688 Example :
5689 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5690 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5691 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5692 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5693
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005694 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5695 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005696
5697
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005698reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5699reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005700 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5702 no | yes | yes | yes
5703 Arguments :
5704 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5705 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5706 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5707 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5708 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5709 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5710
5711 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5712 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5713 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5714 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005715 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005720 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5721 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5722 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5723
5724 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5725 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5726 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5727 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5728 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5729
5730 Example :
5731 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005732 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005733 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5734 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5735
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005736 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5737 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005738
5739
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005740reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5741reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005742 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 no | yes | yes | yes
5745 Arguments :
5746 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5747 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5748 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5749 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5750 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5751 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5752 ignores case.
5753
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005754 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5755 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5756
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005757 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5758 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005759 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5760 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5761 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005762 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5763 not set.
5764
5765 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5766 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5767 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5768 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5769 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5770
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005771 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005772 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5773 # block all others.
5774 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5775 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5776
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005777 # block bad guys
5778 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5779 reqitarpit . if badguys
5780
5781 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5782 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005783
5784
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005785retries <value>
5786 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | no | yes | yes
5789 Arguments :
5790 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5791 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5792 default value is 3.
5793
5794 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5795 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5796 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5797
5798 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5799 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5800
5801 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5802 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5803
5804 See also : "option redispatch"
5805
5806
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005807rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005808 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 no | yes | yes | yes
5811 Arguments :
5812 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5813 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005814 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005815
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005816 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5817 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5818
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005819 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5820 the last header of an HTTP response.
5821
5822 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5823 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5824 responses.
5825
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005826 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5827 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005828
5829
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005830rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5831rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005832 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5834 no | yes | yes | yes
5835 Arguments :
5836 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5837 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5838 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5839 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5840 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5841 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5842 ignores case.
5843
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005844 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5845 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5846
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005847 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5848 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005849 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005850 client.
5851
5852 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5853 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5854 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5855
5856 Example :
5857 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005858 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005859
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005860 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5861 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005862
5863
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005864rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5865rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005866 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 no | yes | yes | yes
5869 Arguments :
5870 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5871 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5872 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5873 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5874 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5875 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5876 ignores case.
5877
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005878 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5879 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5880
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005881 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5882 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5883 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5884 case-sensitive.
5885
5886 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005887 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5888 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5889 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005890
5891 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5892 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5893
5894 Example :
5895 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5896 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5897
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005898 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5899 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005900
5901
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005902rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5903rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005904 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5906 no | yes | yes | yes
5907 Arguments :
5908 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5909 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5910 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5911 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5912 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5913 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5914 ignores case.
5915
5916 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5917 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5918 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5919 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005920 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005921
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005922 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5923 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5924
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005925 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5926 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5927 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5928
5929 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5930 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5931 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5932 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5933 are not case-sensitive.
5934
5935 Example :
5936 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5937 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5938
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005939 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5940 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005941
5942
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005943server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005944 Declare a server in a backend
5945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5946 no | no | yes | yes
5947 Arguments :
5948 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005949 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005950 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005952 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5953 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5954 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5955 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005956 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5957 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5958 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5959 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5960 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005961 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5962 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5963 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5964 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5965 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5966 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5967 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005968 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005969 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5970 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5971 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5972 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005973
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005974 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005975 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5976 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5977 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5978 adding this value to the client's port.
5979
5980 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5981 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005982 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005983
5984 Examples :
5985 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5986 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005987 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005988 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5989 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5990 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005991
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005992 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5993 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005994
5995
5996source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005997source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005998source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005999 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6001 yes | no | yes | yes
6002 Arguments :
6003 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6004 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006005
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006006 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006007 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6008 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6009 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6010 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6011 supported prefixes are :
6012 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6013 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6014 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006015 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006016 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6017 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6018 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6019 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006020
6021 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6022 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006023 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6024 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6025 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006026
6027 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6028 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6029 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6030 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6031 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6032 <addr>.
6033
6034 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6035 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6036 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6037 port.
6038
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006039 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6040 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6041 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6042 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006043 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006044 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6045 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6046 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6047 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6048 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6049 HTTP header.
6050
6051 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6052 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006053 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006054 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6055 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6056 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6057 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6058 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6059 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6060 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6061
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006062 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6063 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6064 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6065 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6066 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6067 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6068
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006069 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6070 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6071 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6072 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6073
6074 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6075 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6076 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6077 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6078 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6079 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6080
6081 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6082 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6083 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6084 there are two methods :
6085
6086 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6087 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6088 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6089 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6090 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6091 of the client ranges may be used.
6092
6093 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6094 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6095 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6096 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6097 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6098 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6099 same session.
6100
6101 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6102 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6103 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6104 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6105 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6106 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6107
6108 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6109 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6110 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006111 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006112
6113 Examples :
6114 backend private
6115 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6116 source 192.168.1.200
6117
6118 backend transparent_ssl1
6119 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6120 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6121
6122 backend transparent_ssl2
6123 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6124 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6125 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6126
6127 backend transparent_ssl3
6128 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6129 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6130 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6131
6132 backend transparent_smtp
6133 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6134 # with Tproxy version 4.
6135 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6136
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006137 backend transparent_http
6138 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6139 # proxy.
6140 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006142 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006143 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006145
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006146srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6147 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6149 yes | no | yes | yes
6150 Arguments :
6151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6153 as explained at the top of this document.
6154
6155 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6156 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6157 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6158 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6159 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6160 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6161 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6162
6163 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6164 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6165 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6166 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6167 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006168 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006169 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006170 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006171
6172 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6173 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6174 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6175 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6176 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6177 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6178
6179 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6180 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6181
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006182 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6183 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006184
6185
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006186stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6187 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006189 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006190
6191 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6192 matched.
6193
6194 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6195 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6196
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006197 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6198 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6199 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6200
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006201 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6202 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6203 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6204 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006205
6206 Example :
6207 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6208 backend stats_localhost
6209 stats enable
6210 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6211
6212 Example :
6213 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6214 backend stats_auth
6215 stats enable
6216 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6217 stats admin if TRUE
6218
6219 Example :
6220 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6221 userlist stats-auth
6222 group admin users admin
6223 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6224 group readonly users haproxy
6225 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6226
6227 backend stats_auth
6228 stats enable
6229 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6230 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6231 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6232 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6233
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006234 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6235 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6236 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006237
6238
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006239stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6240 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006242 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006243 Arguments :
6244 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6245
6246 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6247
6248 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6249 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6250 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6251 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6252 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6253 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6254
6255 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6256 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6257 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006258 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006259
6260 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6261 report using "stats scope".
6262
6263 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6264 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6265 unobvious parameters.
6266
6267 Example :
6268 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6269 backend public_www
6270 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6271 stats enable
6272 stats hide-version
6273 stats scope .
6274 stats uri /admin?stats
6275 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6276 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6277 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6278
6279 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6280 backend private_monitoring
6281 stats enable
6282 stats uri /admin?stats
6283 stats refresh 5s
6284
6285 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6286
6287
6288stats enable
6289 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006291 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006292 Arguments : none
6293
6294 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6295 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6296 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6297 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6298 - stats auth : no authentication
6299 - stats scope : no restriction
6300
6301 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6302 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6303 unobvious parameters.
6304
6305 Example :
6306 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6307 backend public_www
6308 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6309 stats enable
6310 stats hide-version
6311 stats scope .
6312 stats uri /admin?stats
6313 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6314 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6315 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6316
6317 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6318 backend private_monitoring
6319 stats enable
6320 stats uri /admin?stats
6321 stats refresh 5s
6322
6323 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6324
6325
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006326stats hide-version
6327 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006329 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006330 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006331
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006332 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6333 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6334 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6335 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6336 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6337 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006339 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6340 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6341 unobvious parameters.
6342
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006343 Example :
6344 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6345 backend public_www
6346 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006347 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006348 stats hide-version
6349 stats scope .
6350 stats uri /admin?stats
6351 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6352 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6353 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006354
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006355 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6356 backend private_monitoring
6357 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006358 stats uri /admin?stats
6359 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006360
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006361 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006362
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006363
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006364stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6365 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6366 Access control for statistics
6367
6368 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6369 no | no | yes | yes
6370
6371 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6372 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6373 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6374 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6375 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6376 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6377
6378 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6379 instance.
6380
6381 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6382 about ACL usage.
6383
6384
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006385stats realm <realm>
6386 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006389 Arguments :
6390 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6391 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6392 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6393
6394 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6395 using a backslash ('\').
6396
6397 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6398 only related to authentication.
6399
6400 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6401 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6402 unobvious parameters.
6403
6404 Example :
6405 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6406 backend public_www
6407 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6408 stats enable
6409 stats hide-version
6410 stats scope .
6411 stats uri /admin?stats
6412 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6413 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6414 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6415
6416 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6417 backend private_monitoring
6418 stats enable
6419 stats uri /admin?stats
6420 stats refresh 5s
6421
6422 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6423
6424
6425stats refresh <delay>
6426 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006428 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006429 Arguments :
6430 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6431 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6432 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6433 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6434 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6435 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6436
6437 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6438 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6439 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6440 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6441
6442 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6443 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6444 unobvious parameters.
6445
6446 Example :
6447 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6448 backend public_www
6449 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6450 stats enable
6451 stats hide-version
6452 stats scope .
6453 stats uri /admin?stats
6454 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6455 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6456 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6457
6458 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6459 backend private_monitoring
6460 stats enable
6461 stats uri /admin?stats
6462 stats refresh 5s
6463
6464 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6465
6466
6467stats scope { <name> | "." }
6468 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006470 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006471 Arguments :
6472 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6473 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6474 section in which the statement appears.
6475
6476 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6477 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6478 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6479 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6480 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6481 exists.
6482
6483 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6484 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6485 unobvious parameters.
6486
6487 Example :
6488 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6489 backend public_www
6490 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6491 stats enable
6492 stats hide-version
6493 stats scope .
6494 stats uri /admin?stats
6495 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6496 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6497 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6498
6499 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6500 backend private_monitoring
6501 stats enable
6502 stats uri /admin?stats
6503 stats refresh 5s
6504
6505 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6506
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006507
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006508stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006509 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006511 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006512
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006513 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006514 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6515
6516 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6517 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6518
6519 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6520 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006521 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006522
6523 Example :
6524 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6525 backend private_monitoring
6526 stats enable
6527 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6528 stats uri /admin?stats
6529 stats refresh 5s
6530
6531 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6532 global section.
6533
6534
6535stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006536 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6538 yes | yes | yes | yes
6539 Arguments : none
6540
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006541 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006542 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6543 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6544 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6545 - IP (socket, server)
6546 - cookie (backend, server)
6547
6548 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6549 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006550 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006551
6552 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6553
6554
6555stats show-node [ <name> ]
6556 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006558 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006559 Arguments:
6560 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6561 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6562
6563 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6564 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006565 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006566
6567 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6568 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6569 unobvious parameters.
6570
6571 Example:
6572 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6573 backend private_monitoring
6574 stats enable
6575 stats show-node Europe-1
6576 stats uri /admin?stats
6577 stats refresh 5s
6578
6579 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6580 section.
6581
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006582
6583stats uri <prefix>
6584 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006586 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006587 Arguments :
6588 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6589 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6590 query string.
6591
6592 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6593 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6594 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6595 possible to reach it in the application.
6596
6597 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006598 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006599 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6600 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6601 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6602 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6603
6604 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6605 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6606 an address or a port to statistics only.
6607
6608 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6609 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6610 unobvious parameters.
6611
6612 Example :
6613 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6614 backend public_www
6615 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6616 stats enable
6617 stats hide-version
6618 stats scope .
6619 stats uri /admin?stats
6620 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6621 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6622 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6623
6624 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6625 backend private_monitoring
6626 stats enable
6627 stats uri /admin?stats
6628 stats refresh 5s
6629
6630 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6631
6632
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006633stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6634 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006636 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006637
6638 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006639 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006640 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6641 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6642 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6643
6644 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6645 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6646 the "stick-table" statement.
6647
6648 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6649 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6650 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6651 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6652 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6653
6654 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6655 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6656 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6657 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6658 transformation rules.
6659
6660 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6661 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6662 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6663 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6664 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6665 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6666 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6667
6668 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6669 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6670 ACL based conditions.
6671
6672 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6673 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6674 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6675 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6676
6677 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6678 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6679 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6680 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6681
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006682 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6683 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6684 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6685
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006686 Example :
6687 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6688 # last 30 minutes
6689 backend pop
6690 mode tcp
6691 balance roundrobin
6692 stick store-request src
6693 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6694 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6695 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6696
6697 backend smtp
6698 mode tcp
6699 balance roundrobin
6700 stick match src table pop
6701 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6702 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6703
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006704 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006705 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006706
6707
6708stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6709 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6711 no | no | yes | yes
6712
6713 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6714 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6715 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6716 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006718 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6719 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6720 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6721
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006722 Examples :
6723 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006724 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006725
6726 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6727 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6728 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6729
6730
6731 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6732 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6733 backend http
6734 mode http
6735 balance roundrobin
6736 stick on src table https
6737 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6738 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6739 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6740
6741 backend https
6742 mode tcp
6743 balance roundrobin
6744 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6745 stick on src
6746 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6747 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6748
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006749 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006750
6751
6752stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6753 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 no | no | yes | yes
6756
6757 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006758 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006759 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6760 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6761 server is selected.
6762
6763 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6764 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6765 the "stick-table" statement.
6766
6767 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6768 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6769 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6770 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6771 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6772 address.
6773
6774 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6775 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6776 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6777 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6778 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6779 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6780 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6781 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6782 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6783 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6784
6785 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6786 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6787 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6788 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6789 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6790 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6791 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6792
6793 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6794 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6795 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6796 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6797
6798 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6799 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6800 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6801 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6802 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6803 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006804 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6805 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6806 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6807 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6808 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6809 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006810
6811 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6812 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6813 the request.
6814
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006815 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6816 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6817 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6818
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006819 Example :
6820 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6821 # last 30 minutes
6822 backend pop
6823 mode tcp
6824 balance roundrobin
6825 stick store-request src
6826 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6827 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6828 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6829
6830 backend smtp
6831 mode tcp
6832 balance roundrobin
6833 stick match src table pop
6834 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6835 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6836
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006837 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006838 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006839
6840
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006841stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006842 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6843 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006844 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006846 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006847
6848 Arguments :
6849 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6850 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6851 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6852 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6853
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006854 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6855 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6856 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6857 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6858
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006859 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6860 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6861 instance.
6862
6863 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6864 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6865 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6866 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6867 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6868 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006869 to 32 characters.
6870
6871 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6872 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6873 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006874 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006875 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6876 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006877
6878 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006879 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6880 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006881 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6882 increase.
6883
6884 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006885 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6886 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6887 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006888
6889 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6890 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6891 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6892 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6893 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6894 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6895 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6896 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6897 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6898 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6899 parameter (see below).
6900
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006901 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6902 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6903 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6904 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6905 soft restart.
6906
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006907 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6908
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006909 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6910 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6911 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6912 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6913 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006914 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006915 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6916 if not expiration delay is specified.
6917
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006918 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6919 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6920 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6921 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006922 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6923 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6924 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6925 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6926 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6927 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6928 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6929 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6930 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6931 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6932 types and their arguments.
6933
6934 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6935 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6936 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6937 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6938
6939 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6940 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6941 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6942 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6943
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006944 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6945 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6946 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6947 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6948 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6949 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6950
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006951 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6952 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6953 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6954 they were received.
6955
6956 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6957 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6958 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6959 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6960 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6961
6962 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6963 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6964 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6965 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6966 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6967
6968 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6969 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6970 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6971
6972 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6973 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6974 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6975 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6976 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6977
6978 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6979 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6980 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6981 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6982 the client side.
6983
6984 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6985 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6986 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6987 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6988 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6989 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6990 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6991
6992 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6993 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6994 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6995 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6996 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6997 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6998 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6999
7000 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7001 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7002 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7003 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7004 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7005 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7006
7007 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7008 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7009 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7010 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7011
7012 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7013 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7014 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7015 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7016 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7017 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7018 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7019 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7020 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7021 recommended for better fairness.
7022
7023 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7024 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7025 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7026 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7027
7028 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7029 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7030 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7031 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7032 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7033 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7034 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7035 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7036 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7037 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007038
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007039 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7040 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007041 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7042 reference it.
7043
7044 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7045 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7046 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7047 as an exclusive stickiness.
7048
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007049 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7050 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7051 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7052 something that can be ignored.
7053
7054 Example:
7055 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7056 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7057 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7058 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7059
7060 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007061 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007062
7063
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007064stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7065 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 no | no | yes | yes
7068
7069 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007070 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007071 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7072 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7073 server is selected.
7074
7075 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7076 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7077 the "stick-table" statement.
7078
7079 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7080 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7081 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7082 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7083
7084 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7085 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7086 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7087 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7088 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7089 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007090 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007091 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7092 rules.
7093
7094 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7095 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7096 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7097 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7098 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7099 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7100 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7101
7102 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7103 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7104 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7105 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7106
7107 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7108 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7109 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7110 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7111 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7112 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007113 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7114 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7115 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7116 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7117 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7118 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7119 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7120 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7121 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007122
7123 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7124
7125 Example :
7126 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7127 backend https
7128 mode tcp
7129 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007130 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007131 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007132
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007133 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7134 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7135
7136 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7137 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7138 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7139
7140 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7141 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007142
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007143 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7144 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7145 # at offset 44.
7146
7147 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7148 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7149
7150 # Learn on response if server hello.
7151 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007152
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007153 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7154 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7155
7156 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7157 extraction.
7158
7159
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007160tcp-check connect [params*]
7161 Opens a new connection
7162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7163 no | no | yes | yes
7164
7165 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7166 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7167 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7168
7169 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7170 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7171 of the sequence.
7172
7173 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7174 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7175 do.
7176
7177 Parameters :
7178 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7179 use the TCP connection.
7180
7181 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7182 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7183 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7184
7185 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7186
7187 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7188
7189 Examples:
7190 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7191 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7192 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7193 option tcp-check
7194 tcp-check connect
7195 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7196 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7197 tcp-check send \r\n
7198 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7199 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7200 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7201 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7202 tcp-check send \r\n
7203 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7204 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7205
7206 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7207 option tcp-check
7208 tcp-check connect port 110
7209 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7210 tcp-check connect port 143
7211 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7212 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7213
7214 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7215
7216
7217tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7218 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7220 no | no | yes | yes
7221
7222 Arguments :
7223 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7224 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7225 binary.
7226 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7227 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7228 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7229
7230 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7231 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7232 with the usual backslash ('\').
7233 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7234 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7235 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7236 used upper or lower case.
7237
7238
7239 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7240
7241 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7242 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7243 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7244 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7245 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7246 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7247 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7248 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7249
7250 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7251 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7252 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7253 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7254 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7255 expression.
7256
7257 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7258 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7259 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7260 this exact hexadecimal string.
7261 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7262
7263 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7264 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7265 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7266 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7267 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7268 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7269 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7270 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7271 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7272 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7273 the null character.
7274
7275 Examples :
7276 # perform a POP check
7277 option tcp-check
7278 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7279
7280 # perform an IMAP check
7281 option tcp-check
7282 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7283
7284 # look for the redis master server
7285 option tcp-check
7286 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7287 tcp-check expect +PONG
7288 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7289 tcp-check expect string role:master
7290 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7291 tcp-check expect string +OK
7292
7293
7294 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7295 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7296
7297
7298tcp-check send <data>
7299 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7301 no | no | yes | yes
7302
7303 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7304 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7305
7306 Examples :
7307 # look for the redis master server
7308 option tcp-check
7309 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7310 tcp-check expect string role:master
7311
7312 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7313 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7314
7315
7316tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7317 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7318 tcp health check
7319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7320 no | no | yes | yes
7321
7322 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7323 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7324 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7325 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7326 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7327 hexadecimal string.
7328 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7329
7330 Examples :
7331 # redis check in binary
7332 option tcp-check
7333 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7334 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7335
7336
7337 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7338 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7339
7340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007341tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7342 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7344 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007345 Arguments :
7346 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007347 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7348 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007349
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007350 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007351
7352 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7353 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007354 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7355 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7356 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7357 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7358 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7359 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007360
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007361 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7362 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7363 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7364 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007365
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007366 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007367 - accept :
7368 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7369 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7370 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007371
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007372 - reject :
7373 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7374 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7375 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7376 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7377 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7378 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7379 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7380 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7381 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7382 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7383 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7384 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007385
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007386 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7387 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7388 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7389 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7390 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7391 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7392 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7393 hosts.
7394
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007395 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7396 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7397 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7398 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7399 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7400 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7401 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7402 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7403 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7404 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7405 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7406
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007407 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007408 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7409 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7410 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007411 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7412 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007413 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007414 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7415 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7416 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7417 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7418 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007420 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007421 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007422 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007423 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7424 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7425 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7426 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007427
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007428 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7429 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7430 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7431 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007432
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007433 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7434 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7435 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7436 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7437 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007438 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7439 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7440 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7441 layer7 information is extracted.
7442
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007443 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7444 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7445 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7446 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7447 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007449 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7450 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7451 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007453 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7454 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7455 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007457 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007458 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007459 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007460
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007461 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7462 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7463 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007464
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007465 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007466 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7467 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007468
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007469 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7470
7471 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7472
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007473 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007475 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007476
7477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007478tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7479 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007481 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007482 Arguments :
7483 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007484 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007485 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7486 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007488 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007489
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007490 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7491 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7492 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7493 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7494 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007496 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7497 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7498 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7499 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007500 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7501 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7502 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7503 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7504 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7505 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007506 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007507 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007509 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7510 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7511 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7512 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007513
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007514 Four types of actions are supported :
7515 - accept : the request is accepted
7516 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7517 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007518 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007520 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7521 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007522
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007523 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7524 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7525 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7526 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7527 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7528 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007530 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007531 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7532 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007534 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007535 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7536 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7537 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7538 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007539 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7540 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7541 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007542
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007543 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7544 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7545 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7546 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7547
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007548 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007549 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7550 # and reject everything else.
7551 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7552 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007553 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007554 tcp-request content reject
7555
7556 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007557 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7558 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7559 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007560 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007561
7562 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7563 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7564 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007565 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007566 tcp-request content reject
7567
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007568 Example:
7569 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7570 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007571 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007572
7573 Example:
7574 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7575 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007576 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007578 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7579 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7580
7581 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007582 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007583 # protecting all our sites
7584 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007585 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7586 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007587 ...
7588 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7589
7590 backend http_dynamic
7591 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007592 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007593 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007594 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7595 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7596 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007597 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007599 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007600
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007601 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007602
7603
7604tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7605 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007607 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007608 Arguments :
7609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7611 as explained at the top of this document.
7612
7613 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7614 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7615 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7616 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7617 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7618
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007619 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7620 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7621 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7622 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7623
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007624 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7625 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007626 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007627 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007628 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7629 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7630 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7631 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007632
7633 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7634 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7635 it pass through unaffected.
7636
7637 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7638 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7639 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007640 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007641 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7642 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007643 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7644 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7645 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007646
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007647 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007648 "timeout client".
7649
7650
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007651tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7652 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7654 no | no | yes | yes
7655 Arguments :
7656 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007657 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007658
7659 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7660
7661 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7662 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7663 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007664 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7665 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007666
7667 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7668
7669 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7670 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7671 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7672 inserted.
7673
7674 Two types of actions are supported :
7675 - accept :
7676 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7677 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7678 the rules evaluation.
7679
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007680 - close :
7681 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7682 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7683 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7684 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7685 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7686 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007687 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007688 protocols.
7689
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007690 - reject :
7691 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7692 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007693 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007694
7695 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7696 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7697 for changing the default action to a reject.
7698
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007699 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7700 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7701 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7702 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007703 period.
7704
7705 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7706
7707 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7708
7709
7710tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7711 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 no | no | yes | yes
7714 Arguments :
7715 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7716 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7717 as explained at the top of this document.
7718
7719 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7720
7721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007722timeout check <timeout>
7723 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7724 established.
7725
7726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7727 yes | no | yes | yes
7728 Arguments:
7729 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7730 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7731 as explained at the top of this document.
7732
7733 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7734 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7735 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7736 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007737 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7738 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7739 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007740
7741 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7742 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7743
7744 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7745 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007746 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007747
7748 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7749 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7750 forget about it.
7751
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007752 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7753 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007754
7755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007756timeout client <timeout>
7757timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7758 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 yes | yes | yes | no
7761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7764 as explained at the top of this document.
7765
7766 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7767 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7768 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7769 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7770 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7771 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7772 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7773 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007774 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007775 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007776 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7777 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007778 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7779 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007780
7781 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7782 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7783 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7784 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7785 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7786 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7787
7788 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7789 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7790 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7791
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007792 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007793
7794
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007795timeout client-fin <timeout>
7796 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7798 yes | yes | yes | no
7799 Arguments :
7800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7802 as explained at the top of this document.
7803
7804 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7805 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7806 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7807 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7808 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7809 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7810 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7811 down in one direction.
7812
7813 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7814 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7815 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7816
7817 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7818
7819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007820timeout connect <timeout>
7821timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7822 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 yes | no | yes | yes
7825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7828 as explained at the top of this document.
7829
7830 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007831 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007832 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007833 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007834 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7835 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007836
7837 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7838 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7839 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7840 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7841 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7842 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7843
7844 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7845 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7846 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7847
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007848 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7849 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007850
7851
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007852timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7853 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7855 yes | yes | yes | yes
7856 Arguments :
7857 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7858 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7859 as explained at the top of this document.
7860
7861 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7862 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7863 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7864 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7865 once the request has started to present itself.
7866
7867 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7868 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7869 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7870 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7871 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7872
7873 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7874 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7875 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7876 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7877
7878 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7879 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7880 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7881 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7882 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007883 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007884
7885 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7886 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7887 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7888 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7889
7890 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7891
7892
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007893timeout http-request <timeout>
7894 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007896 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007897 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7900 as explained at the top of this document.
7901
7902 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7903 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7904 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7905 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7906 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7907 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7908 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007909 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7910 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7911 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7912 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7913 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7914 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7915 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007916
7917 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7918 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007919 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7920 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007921
7922 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7923 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7924 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7925 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7926 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7927
7928 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007929 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7930 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7931 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007932
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007933 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007934
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007935
7936timeout queue <timeout>
7937 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 yes | no | yes | yes
7940 Arguments :
7941 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7942 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7943 as explained at the top of this document.
7944
7945 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7946 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7947 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7948 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7949 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7950
7951 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7952 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7953 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7954 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7955
7956 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7957
7958
7959timeout server <timeout>
7960timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7961 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | no | yes | yes
7964 Arguments :
7965 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7966 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7967 as explained at the top of this document.
7968
7969 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7970 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7971 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7972 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7973 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7974 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7975 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7976
7977 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7978 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7979 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7980 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7981 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007982 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007983 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007984 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7985 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7986 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7987 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007988
7989 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7990 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7991 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7992 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7993 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7994 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7995
7996 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7997 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7998 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7999
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008000 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008001
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008002
8003timeout server-fin <timeout>
8004 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8006 yes | no | yes | yes
8007 Arguments :
8008 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8009 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8010 as explained at the top of this document.
8011
8012 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8013 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8014 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8015 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8016 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8017 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8018 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8019 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8020 situations, it should not be needed.
8021
8022 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8023 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8024 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8025
8026 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8027
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008028
8029timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008030 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8032 yes | yes | yes | yes
8033 Arguments :
8034 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8035 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8036 as explained at the top of this document.
8037
8038 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8039 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8040 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8041
8042 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8043 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8044 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8045 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008046 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008047
8048 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8049
8050
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008051timeout tunnel <timeout>
8052 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8054 yes | no | yes | yes
8055 Arguments :
8056 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8057 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8058 as explained at the top of this document.
8059
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008060 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008061 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8062 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8063 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8064 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8065 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8066 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8067 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8068 specified.
8069
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008070 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8071 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8072 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8073 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8074 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8075 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8076 state.
8077
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008078 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8079 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8080 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8081 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8082 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8083
8084 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8085 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8086 forget about it.
8087
8088 Example :
8089 defaults http
8090 option http-server-close
8091 timeout connect 5s
8092 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008093 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008094 timeout server 30s
8095 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8096
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008097 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008098
8099
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008100transparent (deprecated)
8101 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008103 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008104 Arguments : none
8105
8106 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8107 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8108 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8109 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8110 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8111 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8112 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8113 appropriate server.
8114
8115 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8116
8117 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8118 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8119
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008120 See also: "option transparent"
8121
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008122unique-id-format <string>
8123 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 yes | yes | yes | no
8126 Arguments :
8127 <string> is a log-format string.
8128
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008129 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8130 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8131 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8132 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008133
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008134 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8135 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8136 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8137 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8138 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8139 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8140 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8141 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008142
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008143 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8144 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008145
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008146 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008147
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008148 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008149
8150 will generate:
8151
8152 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8153
8154 See also: "unique-id-header"
8155
8156unique-id-header <name>
8157 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8159 yes | yes | yes | no
8160 Arguments :
8161 <name> is the name of the header.
8162
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008163 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8164 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008165
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008166 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008167
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008168 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008169 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8170
8171 will generate:
8172
8173 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8174
8175 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008176
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008177use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008178 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8180 no | yes | yes | no
8181 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008182 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8183 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008184
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008185 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8186 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008187
8188 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8189 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8190 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008191 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8192 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8193 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8194 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008195
8196 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8197 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8198 assign the backend.
8199
8200 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8201 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8202 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8203 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8204 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8205 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8206
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008207 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008208 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008209 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8210 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8211 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8212
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008213 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8214 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8215 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8216 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8217 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8218 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8219 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8220 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8221 cannot be forced from the request.
8222
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008223 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008224 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8225 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8226
8227 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8228 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008229
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008230
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008231use-server <server> if <condition>
8232use-server <server> unless <condition>
8233 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8235 no | no | yes | yes
8236 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008237 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008238
8239 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8240
8241 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8242 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8243 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8244
8245 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8246 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8247 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8248 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8249 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8250 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8251 matches will assign the server.
8252
8253 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8254 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8255 with the next rules until one matches.
8256
8257 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8258 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8259 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8260 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8261
8262 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8263 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8264 stripped.
8265
8266 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8267 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8268 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8269 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8270
8271 Example :
8272 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8273 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8274 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8275 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8276 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8277 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8278 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8279 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8280 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8281
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008282 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008283
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008284
82855. Bind and Server options
8286--------------------------
8287
8288The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8289depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8290settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8291written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8292described in this section.
8293
8294
82955.1. Bind options
8296-----------------
8297
8298The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8299as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8300no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8301parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8302while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8303provided immediately after the setting name.
8304
8305The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8306
8307accept-proxy
8308 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008309 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8310 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008311 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8312 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8313 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8314 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8315 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8316 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8317 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008318 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8319 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008320
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008321alpn <protocols>
8322 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8323 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8324 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8325 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8326 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8327 initial NPN extension.
8328
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008329backlog <backlog>
8330 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8331 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8332
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008333ecdhe <named curve>
8334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008335 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8336 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008337
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008338ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008339 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8340 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8341 client's certificate.
8342
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008343ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8345 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8346 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8347 error is ignored.
8348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008349ciphers <ciphers>
8350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8351 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008352 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008353 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8354 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8355
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008356crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8358 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8359 to verify client's certificate.
8360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008361crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8363 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8364 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8365 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8366 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8367 file.
8368
8369 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8370 are loaded.
8371
8372 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008373 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8374 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008375 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8376 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8377 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8378 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8379 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8380 www.sub.example.org).
8381
8382 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8383 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8384 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8385 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8386 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8387
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008388 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008389
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008390 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8391 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008392 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008393 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8394 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8395 clients).
8396
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008397 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8398 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8399 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8400 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8401 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8402 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8403 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8404 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8405 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8406 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8407 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8408 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8409 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8410
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008411crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8413 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008414 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008415 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008416
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008417crt-list <file>
8418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008419 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8420 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008421
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008422 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008423
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008424 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8425 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8426 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8427 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8428 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8429 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8430 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8431 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008433defer-accept
8434 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8435 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8436 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8437 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8438 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8439 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8440 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8441 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8442 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8443 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8444 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8445
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008446force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008447 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008448 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8449 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8450
8451force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008452 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008453 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8454
8455force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008456 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008457 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8458
8459force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008460 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008461 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8462
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008463gid <gid>
8464 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8465 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8466 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8467 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8468 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8469
8470group <group>
8471 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8472 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8473 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8474 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8475 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8476
8477id <id>
8478 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8479 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8480 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8481 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8482
8483interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008484 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8485 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8486 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8487 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8488 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8489 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8490 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008491
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008492level <level>
8493 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8494 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8495 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8496 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8497 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8498 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8499 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8500 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8501 counters).
8502 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8503 all counters).
8504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008505maxconn <maxconn>
8506 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8507 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8508 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8509 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8510 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8511 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8512 eat all memory.
8513
8514mode <mode>
8515 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8516 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8517 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8518 UNIX sockets.
8519
8520mss <maxseg>
8521 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8522 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8523 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8524 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8525 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8526 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8527 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8528 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8529 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8530 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8531 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8532
8533name <name>
8534 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8535 page.
8536
8537nice <nice>
8538 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8539 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8540 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8541 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8542 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8543 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8544 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8545 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8546 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8547 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8548 one for an RDP socket.
8549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008550no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008552 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008553 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008554 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8555 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008556
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008557no-tls-tickets
8558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8559 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8560 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8561 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8562
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008563no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008565 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008566 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8567 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8568 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008570no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008572 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008573 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8574 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8575 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008576
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008577no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008579 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008580 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8581 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8582 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008583
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008584npn <protocols>
8585 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8586 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8587 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8588 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008589 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8590 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008591
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008592process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8593 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8594 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8595 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8596 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8597 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8598 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8599 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008600 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8601 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8602 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8603 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8604 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8605 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8606 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008607
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008608ssl
8609 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008610 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008611 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8612 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8613 to deciphered contents.
8614
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008615strict-sni
8616 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8617 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8618 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8619 See the "crt" option for more information.
8620
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008621tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008622 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008623 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8624 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8625 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8626 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8627 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8628 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8629 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008630 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8631 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8632 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008633
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008634transparent
8635 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8636 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8637 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8638 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8639 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8640 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8641 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8642 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8643 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8644 so check for support with your vendor.
8645
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008646v4v6
8647 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8648 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8649 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8650 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008651 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008652
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008653v6only
8654 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8655 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8656 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008657 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8658 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008659
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008660uid <uid>
8661 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8662 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8663 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8664 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8665 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8666
8667user <user>
8668 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8669 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8670 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8671 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8672 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8673
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008674verify [none|optional|required]
8675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8676 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8677 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8678 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8679 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008680 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8681 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8682 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8683 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008684
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086855.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008686------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008688The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8689which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8690arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8691settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8692after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8693Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8694address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008696 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008697 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008699The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008700
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008701addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008702 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8703 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8704 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8705 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8706 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008708 Supported in default-server: No
8709
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008710agent-check
8711 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008712 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8713 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8714 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8715 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008716
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008717 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008718 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8719 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8720
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008721 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8722 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008723
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008724 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8725 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8726 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008727
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008728 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8729 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8730 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008731
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008732 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8733 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8734 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8735 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8736 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8737 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8738 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008739
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008740 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8741 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008742
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008743 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8744 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8745 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8746 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8747 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8748 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8749 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8750 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8751 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008752
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008753 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8754 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008755 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8756 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8757 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8758 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008759
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008760 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8761 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008762
8763 Supported in default-server: No
8764
8765agent-inter <delay>
8766 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8767 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8768
8769 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8770 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8771 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8772 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8773 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8774 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8775 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8776 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8777 of backends use the same servers.
8778
8779 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8780
8781 Supported in default-server: Yes
8782
8783agent-port <port>
8784 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8785
8786 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8787
8788 Supported in default-server: Yes
8789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008790backup
8791 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8792 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8793 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8794 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8795 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8796 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008798 Supported in default-server: No
8799
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008800ca-file <cafile>
8801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8802 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8803 server's certificate.
8804
8805 Supported in default-server: No
8806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008807check
8808 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008809 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8810 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8811 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8812 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8813 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8814 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8815 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008816 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8817 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8818 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008820 Supported in default-server: No
8821
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008822check-send-proxy
8823 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8824 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8825 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8826 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8827 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8828 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8829 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8830
8831 Supported in default-server: No
8832
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008833check-ssl
8834 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8835 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8836 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8837 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008838 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008839 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8840 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8841 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8842 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8843
8844 Supported in default-server: No
8845
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008846ciphers <ciphers>
8847 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008848 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008849 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8850 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8851 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8852 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8853 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8854 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8855
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008856 Supported in default-server: No
8857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008858cookie <value>
8859 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8860 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8861 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8862 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8863 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8864 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8865 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008867 Supported in default-server: No
8868
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008869crl-file <crlfile>
8870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8871 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8872 to verify server's certificate.
8873
8874 Supported in default-server: No
8875
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008876crt <cert>
8877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8878 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8879 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8880 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8881 certificate request.
8882
8883 Supported in default-server: No
8884
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008885disabled
8886 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8887 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8888 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8889 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8890 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8891
8892 Supported in default-server: No
8893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008894error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008895 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8896 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8897 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008899 Supported in default-server: Yes
8900
8901 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008903fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008904 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8905 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8906 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008908 Supported in default-server: Yes
8909
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008910force-sslv3
8911 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8912 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8913 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8914
8915 Supported in default-server: No
8916
8917force-tlsv10
8918 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8919 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8920
8921 Supported in default-server: No
8922
8923force-tlsv11
8924 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8925 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8926
8927 Supported in default-server: No
8928
8929force-tlsv12
8930 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8931 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8932
8933 Supported in default-server: No
8934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008935id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008936 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8937 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8938 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008939
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008940 Supported in default-server: No
8941
8942inter <delay>
8943fastinter <delay>
8944downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008945 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8946 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8947 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8948 between checks depending on the server state :
8949
8950 Server state | Interval used
8951 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8952 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8953 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8954 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8955 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8956 or yet unchecked. |
8957 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8958 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8959 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008961 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8962 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8963 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8964 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008965 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8966 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8967 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8968 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8969 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008971 Supported in default-server: Yes
8972
8973maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008974 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8975 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8976 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8977 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8978 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8979 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8980 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8981 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008983 Supported in default-server: Yes
8984
8985maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008986 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8987 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8988 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8989 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8990 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8991 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8992 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008994 Supported in default-server: Yes
8995
8996minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008997 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8998 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8999 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9000 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9001 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9002 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009003 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009004 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009006 Supported in default-server: Yes
9007
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009008no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009009 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9010 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009011 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009012
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009013 Supported in default-server: No
9014
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009015no-tls-tickets
9016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9017 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9018 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
9019 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
9020
9021 Supported in default-server: No
9022
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009023no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009024 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009025 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9026 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009027 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9028 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009029
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009030 Supported in default-server: No
9031
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009032no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009033 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009034 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9035 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009036 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9037 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009038
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009039 Supported in default-server: No
9040
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009041no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009042 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009043 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9044 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009045 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9046 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009047
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009048 Supported in default-server: No
9049
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009050non-stick
9051 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9052 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9053 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9054
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009055 Supported in default-server: No
9056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009057observe <mode>
9058 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9059 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9060 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9061 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9062 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9063 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009064 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009066 Supported in default-server: No
9067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009068 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009070on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009071 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9072 Currently, four modes are available:
9073 - fastinter: force fastinter
9074 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9075 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9076 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9077 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009079 Supported in default-server: Yes
9080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009081 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9082
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009083on-marked-down <action>
9084 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9085 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009086 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9087 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9088 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9089 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9090 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9091 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9092 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9093 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009094
9095 Actions are disabled by default
9096
9097 Supported in default-server: Yes
9098
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009099on-marked-up <action>
9100 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9101 Currently one action is available:
9102 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9103 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9104 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9105 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9106 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9107 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9108 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9109 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9110
9111 Actions are disabled by default
9112
9113 Supported in default-server: Yes
9114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009115port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009116 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9117 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9118 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9119 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9120 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9121 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009123 Supported in default-server: Yes
9124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009125redir <prefix>
9126 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9127 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9128 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9129 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9130 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9131 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9132 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9133 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009134 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009135 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9136 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9137 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9138 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9139 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9140
9141 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009143 Supported in default-server: No
9144
9145rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009146 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9147 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9148 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009150 Supported in default-server: Yes
9151
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009152send-proxy
9153 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9154 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9155 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9156 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9157 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9158 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9159 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9160 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9161 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009162 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9163 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9164 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9165 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9166 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009167
9168 Supported in default-server: No
9169
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009170send-proxy-v2
9171 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9172 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9173 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9174 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9175 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9176 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9177 option of the "bind" keyword.
9178
9179 Supported in default-server: No
9180
9181send-proxy-v2-ssl
9182 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9183 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9184 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9185 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9186 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9187 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9188 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9189 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9190
9191 Supported in default-server: No
9192
9193send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9194 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9195 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9196 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9197 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9198 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9199 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9200 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9201 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9202 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9203
9204 Supported in default-server: No
9205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009206slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009207 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9208 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9209 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9210 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9211 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9212 parameters :
9213
9214 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9215 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9216
9217 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9218 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9219 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9220 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9221
9222 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9223 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9224 seen as failed.
9225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009226 Supported in default-server: Yes
9227
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009228source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009229source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009230source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009231 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9232 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9233 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9234 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9235
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009236 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9237 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9238 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9239 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9240 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9241 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9242 server.
9243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009244 Supported in default-server: No
9245
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009246ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009247 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9248 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9249 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9250 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9251 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9252 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009253 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009254
9255 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009257track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009258 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9259 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9260 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9261 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009262 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009264 Supported in default-server: No
9265
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009266verify [none|required]
9267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009268 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9269 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9270 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9271 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009272 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9273 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9274 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009275
9276 Supported in default-server: No
9277
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009278verifyhost <hostname>
9279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9280 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9281 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9282 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9283 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9284 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9285
9286 Supported in default-server: No
9287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009288weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009289 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9290 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9291 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009292 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9293 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9294 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9295 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9296 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9297 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009299 Supported in default-server: Yes
9300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009301
93026. HTTP header manipulation
9303---------------------------
9304
9305In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9306response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9307request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9308which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009309against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009310
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009311If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9312to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9313but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9314HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9315stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9316because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9317a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9318still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009320This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9321in section 4.2 :
9322
9323 - reqadd <string>
9324 - reqallow <search>
9325 - reqiallow <search>
9326 - reqdel <search>
9327 - reqidel <search>
9328 - reqdeny <search>
9329 - reqideny <search>
9330 - reqpass <search>
9331 - reqipass <search>
9332 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9333 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9334 - reqtarpit <search>
9335 - reqitarpit <search>
9336 - rspadd <string>
9337 - rspdel <search>
9338 - rspidel <search>
9339 - rspdeny <search>
9340 - rspideny <search>
9341 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9342 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9343
9344With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9345is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9346parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9347prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9348Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9349
9350 \t for a tab
9351 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9352 \n for a new line (LF)
9353 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9354 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9355 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9356 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9357 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9358
9359The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9360portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9361above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9362regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93639 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9364is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9365
9366The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9367after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9368
9369Notes related to these keywords :
9370---------------------------------
9371 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9372 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9373 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9374
9375 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9376 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9377 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9378
9379 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9380 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9381 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9382 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9383 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9384
9385 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9386 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9387 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9388 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9389 useless headers before adding new ones.
9390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009391 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009392 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9393
9394 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9395 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9396 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9397
9398 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9399 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009400 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009401
9402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094037. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9404----------------------------------
9405
9406Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9407client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9408The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9409these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9410but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9411data called patterns.
9412
9413
94147.1. ACL basics
9415---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009416
9417The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9418content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9419from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9420simple :
9421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009422 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009423 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009424 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9425 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009427The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9428adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009429
9430In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009432 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009433
9434This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9435Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9436and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009437an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9438conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9439as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9440are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009441
9442ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9443'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9444which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9445
9446There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9447performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009449The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9450specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9451this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009452methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9453ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009454
9455Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9456 - boolean
9457 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9458 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9459 - string
9460 - data block
9461
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009462Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9463converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9464would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9465The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9466which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9467
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009468Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9469keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9470fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9471which are summarized in the table below :
9472
9473 +---------------------+-----------------+
9474 | Sample or converter | Default |
9475 | output type | matching method |
9476 +---------------------+-----------------+
9477 | boolean | bool |
9478 +---------------------+-----------------+
9479 | integer | int |
9480 +---------------------+-----------------+
9481 | ip | ip |
9482 +---------------------+-----------------+
9483 | string | str |
9484 +---------------------+-----------------+
9485 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9486 +---------------------+-----------------+
9487
9488Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9489matching method, see below.
9490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009491The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9492 - boolean
9493 - integer or integer range
9494 - IP address / network
9495 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9496 - regular expression
9497 - hex block
9498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009499The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9500
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009501 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9502 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009503 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009504 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009505 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009506 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009507 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009509The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9510read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9511if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9512lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9513will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9514beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9515a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9516lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9517exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9518
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009519The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9520parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9521ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9522a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9523check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9524
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009525The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9526socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9527file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009529Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9530loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9531
9532 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9533
9534In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9535the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9536case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9537as well.
9538
9539The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9540sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9541do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9542methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9543is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9544obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9545followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9546default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9547that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9548string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9549
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009550The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9551By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9552string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9553resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9554server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9555waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9556flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9557function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009559There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9560sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9561be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009562
9563 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9564 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009565 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9566 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9567 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9568 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009569
9570 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9571 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009572 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009573
9574 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009575 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009576
9577 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009578 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009579
9580 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9581 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9582
9583 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9584 binary or string samples.
9585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009586 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9587 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009589 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9590 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9591 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009593 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9594 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009596 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9597 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009599 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9600 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009602 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9603 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009604 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009606 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9607 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9608 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009609
9610For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9611request, it is possible to do :
9612
9613 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9614
9615In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9616buffer, one would use the following acl :
9617
9618 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9619
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009620On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9621possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9622
9623 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9626criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9627method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9628to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9629criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9630the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009632If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009633the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9634For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9637 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9638 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9639 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009640
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009641
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009642The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9643types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9644combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9645brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9646default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009648 +-------------------------------------------------+
9649 | Input sample type |
9650 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009651 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009652 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9653 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9654 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009655 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009656 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009657 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009658 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009659 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009660 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009661 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009662 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009663 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009665 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009666 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009667 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009669 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009670 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009671 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009672 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009673 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009675 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009676 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9677 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9678 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009679
9680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096817.1.1. Matching booleans
9682------------------------
9683
9684In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9685Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9686When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9687that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9688
9689Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9690return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9691"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9692
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096947.1.2. Matching integers
9695------------------------
9696
9697Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9698enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9699to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9700
9701Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9702matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9703lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009704
9705For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9706unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9707representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9708
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009709As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9710two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9711instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9712ranges and operators.
9713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009714For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009715operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9716Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9717of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009719Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009720
9721 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9722 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9723 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9724 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9725 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009727For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009728
9729 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9730
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009731This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9732
9733 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9734
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097367.1.3. Matching strings
9737-----------------------
9738
9739String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9740different forms :
9741
9742 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9743 patterns ;
9744
9745 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9746 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9747
9748 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9749 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9750
9751 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9752 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9753
9754 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9755 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9756 matches.
9757
9758 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9759 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9760 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009761
9762String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9763exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9764characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9765string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9766to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009767before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009768
9769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097707.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9771---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009772
9773Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9774they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9775possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9776passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9777the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009778the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9779match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009780
9781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9783-------------------------------------
9784
9785It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9786not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9787a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9788to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9789digits may be used upper or lower case.
9790
9791Example :
9792 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9793 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9794
9795
97967.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9797---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009798
9799IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9800netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9801within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009802host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009803difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9804at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9805does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9806parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009807
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009808IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9809Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9810trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9811IPv6 patterns.
9812
9813HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9814following situations :
9815 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9816 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9817 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9818 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9819 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9820 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9821 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9822 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9823 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9824 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009826
98277.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9828----------------------------------
9829
9830Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9831combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9832
9833 - AND (implicit)
9834 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9835 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009837A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009839 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009841Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9842indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009844For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9845"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9846requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9847is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9848
9849 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9850 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9851 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9852 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9853
9854To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9855and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9856
9857 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9858 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9859 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9860 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9861
9862 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9863 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9864 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9865 use_backend www if host_www
9866
9867It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9868expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9869be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9870the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9871
9872 The following rule :
9873
9874 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9875 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9876
9877 Can also be written that way :
9878
9879 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9880
9881It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9882to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9883simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9884sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9885good use is the following :
9886
9887 With named ACLs :
9888
9889 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9890 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9891 monitor fail if site_dead
9892
9893 With anonymous ACLs :
9894
9895 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9896
9897See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9898
9899
99007.3. Fetching samples
9901---------------------
9902
9903Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9904against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9905sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9906ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9907of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9908available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9909
9910This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9911Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9912compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9913deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9914
9915The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9916matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9917method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9918indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9919
9920As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9921when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9922mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9923the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9924ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9925
9926Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9927multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9928when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9929incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9930are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9931is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9932all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9933
9934Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9935 - name
9936 - name(arg1)
9937 - name(arg1,arg2)
9938
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009939
99407.3.1. Converters
9941-----------------
9942
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009943Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9944of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9945is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9946was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9947has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9948unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9949
9950These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9951sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9952the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9953support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009956
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009957base64
9958 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9959 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9960 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009962hex
9963 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9964 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9965 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9966 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009968http_date([<offset>])
9969 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9970 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9971 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9972 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9973 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9974 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009975
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +02009976in_table(<table>)
9977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
9978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
9979 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
9980 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
9981 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
9982
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009983ipmask(<mask>)
9984 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9985 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9986 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9987 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9988
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009989language(<value>[,<default>])
9990 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9991 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9992 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9993 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9994 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9995 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9996 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9997 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9998 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9999 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10000 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10001 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010002
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010003 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010004
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010005 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10006 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010008 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10009 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10010 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10011 use_backend spanish if es
10012 use_backend french if fr
10013 use_backend english if en
10014 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010015
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010016lower
10017 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10018 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10019 type. The result is of type string.
10020
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010021ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10022 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10023 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10024 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10025 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10026 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10027 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10028
10029 Example :
10030
10031 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10032 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10033 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10034
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010035map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10036map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10037map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10038 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10039 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10040 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10041 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10042 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10043 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10044 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10045 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010046
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010047 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10048 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10049 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010050
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010051 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10052 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010054 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10055 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10056 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10057 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010058 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10059 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010060 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10061 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10062 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10063 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10064 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10065 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10066 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10067 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10068 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10070 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10072 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010074
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010075 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10076 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10077 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10078 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10079 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010080
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010081 Example :
10082
10083 # this is a comment and is ignored
10084 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10085 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10086 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10087 | | | `---------- value
10088 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10089 | `---------------------------- key
10090 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10091
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010092table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10095 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10096 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10097 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10098 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10099
10100
10101table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10105 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10106 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10107 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10108
10109table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10113 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10114 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10115
10116table_conn_cur(<table>)
10117 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10118 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10119 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10120 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10121 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10122
10123table_conn_rate(<table>)
10124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10126 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10127 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10128 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10129
10130table_gpc0(<table>)
10131 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10132 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10133 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10134 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10135 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10136
10137table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10138 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10139 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10140 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10141 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10142 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10143 sample fetch keyword.
10144
10145table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10148 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10149 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10150 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10151
10152table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10153 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10154 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10155 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10156 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10157 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10158 keyword.
10159
10160table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10161 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10162 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10163 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10164 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10165 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10166
10167table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10168 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10169 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10170 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10171 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10172 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10173 keyword.
10174
10175table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10176 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10177 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10178 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10179 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10180 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10181 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10182 keyword.
10183
10184table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10185 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10186 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10187 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10188 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10189 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10190 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10191 keyword.
10192
10193table_server_id(<table>)
10194 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10195 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10196 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10197 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10198 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10199 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10200
10201table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10202 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10203 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10204 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10205 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10206 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10207 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10208 keyword.
10209
10210table_sess_rate(<table>)
10211 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10212 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10213 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10214 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10215 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10216 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10217 keyword.
10218
10219table_trackers(<table>)
10220 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10221 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10222 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10223 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10224 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10225 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10226 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10227 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10228 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10229 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10230
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010231upper
10232 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10233 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10234 type. The result is of type string.
10235
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010236utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10237 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10238 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10239 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10240 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10241 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10242 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10243
10244 Example :
10245
10246 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10247 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10248 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10249
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010250
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102517.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010252--------------------------------------------
10253
10254A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10255not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10256"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10257The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10258
10259always_false : boolean
10260 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10261 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10262
10263always_true : boolean
10264 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10265 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10266
10267avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010268 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010269 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10270 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10271 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10272 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10273 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10274 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10275 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10276 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10277 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10278 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10279 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10280 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10281 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010283be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010284 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10285 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10286 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10287 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10288 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010290be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10292 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10293 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10294 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10295 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10296 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010297
10298 Example :
10299 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10300 backend dynamic
10301 mode http
10302 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10303 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010305connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10306 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010307 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010308 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10309 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010310
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010311 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010312 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010313 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010315 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10316 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010317
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010318 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010319 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010320 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010321 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10322 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010323 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010324 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010325
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010326 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10327 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010328 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010329 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010330
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010331date([<offset>]) : integer
10332 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10333 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10334 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10335 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010336 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10337
10338 Example :
10339
10340 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10341 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010342
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010343env(<name>) : string
10344 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10345 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10346 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10347 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10348 certain way.
10349
10350 Examples :
10351 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10352 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10353
10354 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10355 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010357fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10358 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010359 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10360 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010361 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10362 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10363 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10364 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10365 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010367fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10369 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10370 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10371 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10372 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10373 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10374 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10375 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010376
10377 Example :
10378 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10379 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10380 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10381 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10382 frontend mail
10383 bind :25
10384 mode tcp
10385 maxconn 100
10386 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10387 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10388 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10389 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010391nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10392 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10393 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10394 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010395 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10396 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10397 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010400 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10401 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10402 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010403 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10404 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10405 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10406 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10407 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10408
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010409rand([<range>]) : integer
10410 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10411 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10412 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10413 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10414 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010416srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10418 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10419 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10420 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10421 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10422 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10423 methods.
10424
10425srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10426 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10427 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10428 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10429 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10430 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10431 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10432 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10433
10434srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10435 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10436 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010437 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010438 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10439 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10440 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10441 overloading servers).
10442
10443 Example :
10444 # Redirect to a separate back
10445 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10446 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10447 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10448
10449table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10450 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10451 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10452
10453table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10454 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10455 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10456 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10457
10458
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104597.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010460----------------------------------
10461
10462The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10463closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10464methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10465sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10466TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010467the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10468counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10469"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010470argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10471the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10472this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010473
10474be_id : integer
10475 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10476 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10477
10478dst : ip
10479 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10480 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10481 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10482 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10483 RFC 4291.
10484
10485dst_conn : integer
10486 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10487 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10488 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10489 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10490 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10491 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10492 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10493 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010495dst_port : integer
10496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10497 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10498 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10499 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10500 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10501 an HTTP header.
10502
10503fe_id : integer
10504 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10505 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10506 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10507
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010508sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010509sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10510sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10511sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010512 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10513 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10514 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010516sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010517sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10518sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10519sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010520 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10521 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10522 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10523
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010524sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010525sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10526sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10527sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010528 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10529 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010530 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10531 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10532 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010533
10534 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10535 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010536 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10537 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10538 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010539 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10540 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10541
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010542sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010543sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10544sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10545sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010546 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10547 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10548
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010549sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010550sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10551sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10552sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010553 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10554 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10555 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010557sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010558sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10559sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10560sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010561 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10562 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10563 See also src_conn_rate.
10564
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010565sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010566sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10567sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10568sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010569 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010570 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010571
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010572sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010573sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10574sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10575sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010576 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10577 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10578 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010579 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10580 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10581 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010582
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010583sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010584sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10585sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10586sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010587 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10588 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10589 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10590
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010591sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010592sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10593sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10594sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010595 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10596 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10597 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10598 src_http_err_rate.
10599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010600sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010601sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10602sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10603sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010604 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10605 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10606 src_http_req_cnt.
10607
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010608sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010609sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10610sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10611sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010612 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10613 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10614 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10615 src_http_req_rate.
10616
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010617sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010618sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10619sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10620sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010621 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010622 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10623 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10624 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10625 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010626
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010627 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10628 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010629 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010631sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010632sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10633sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10634sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010635 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10636 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10637 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010638
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010639sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010640sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10641sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10642sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010643 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10644 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10645 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010646
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010647sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010648sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10649sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10650sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010651 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10652 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10653 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10654 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010655 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010656 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10657
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010658sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010659sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10660sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10661sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010662 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10663 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10664 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10665 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10666 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010667 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010669sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010670sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10671sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10672sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010673 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10674 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10675 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10676
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010677sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010678sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10679sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10680sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010681 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10682 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010683 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010684 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10685 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010686 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10687 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10688 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010690so_id : integer
10691 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10692 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10693 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010695src : ip
10696 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10697 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10698 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10699 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10700 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10701 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10702 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010703
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010704 Example:
10705 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10706 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10709 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10710 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10711 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010712 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010714src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10715 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10716 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010717 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010718 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010720src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10721 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10722 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10723 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10724 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10725 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10726 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010727
10728 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10729 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10730 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10731 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010732 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010733 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10734 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010736src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010737 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010738 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010739 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010740 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010742src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010743 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010744 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10745 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010746 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010748src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10749 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10750 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10751 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010752 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010754src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010755 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010756 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010757 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010758 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010760src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010761 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010762 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010763 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10764 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010765 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10766 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10767 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10770 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10771 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010772 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010773 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010774 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010776src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10777 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10778 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10779 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10780 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010781 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010783src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10784 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10785 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10786 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010787 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010789src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10790 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10791 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10792 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010793 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010794 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010796src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10797 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10798 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10799 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010800 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010801 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10802 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010803
10804 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010805 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010806 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010808src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010809 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10810 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10811 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10812 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10813 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010815src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010816 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10817 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10818 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10819 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10820 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010822src_port : integer
10823 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10824 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10825 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10826 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10829 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010830 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10831 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10832 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010833 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010835src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10836 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10837 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10838 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10839 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010840 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010842src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10843 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10844 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10845 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10846 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10847 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10848 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10849 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10850 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010851
10852 Example :
10853 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10854 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10855 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10856 listen ssh
10857 bind :22
10858 mode tcp
10859 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010860 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010861 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010862 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010864srv_id : integer
10865 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10866 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10867 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010868
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010869
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108707.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010873The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10874closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10875when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10876usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010877future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010878
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010879ssl_bc : boolean
10880 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10881 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10882 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10883
10884ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10885 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10886 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10887
10888ssl_bc_cipher : string
10889 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10890 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10891
10892ssl_bc_protocol : string
10893 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10894 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10895
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010896ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010897 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010898 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10899 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010900
10901ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10902 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10903 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10904 if session was reused or not.
10905
10906ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10907 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10908 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010910ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10911 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10912 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10913 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10914 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10915 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10918 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10919 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10920 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10921 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923ssl_c_err : integer
10924 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10925 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10926 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10927 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10928 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10931 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10932 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10933 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10934 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10935 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10936 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10937 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10938 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940ssl_c_key_alg : string
10941 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10942 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10943 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010945ssl_c_notafter : string
10946 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10947 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10948 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010950ssl_c_notbefore : string
10951 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10952 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10953 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010955ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10956 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10957 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10958 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10959 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10960 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10961 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10962 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10963 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010965ssl_c_serial : binary
10966 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10967 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10968 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010970ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10971 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10972 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10973 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010974 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10975 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10976
10977 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010979ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10980 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10981 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10982 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010984ssl_c_used : boolean
10985 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10986 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010988ssl_c_verify : integer
10989 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10990 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10991 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10992 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994ssl_c_version : integer
10995 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10996 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010998ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10999 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11000 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11001 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11002 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011003 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11005 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11006 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011008ssl_f_key_alg : string
11009 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11010 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11011 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011013ssl_f_notafter : string
11014 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11015 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11016 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018ssl_f_notbefore : string
11019 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11020 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11021 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11024 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11025 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11026 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11027 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11028 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11029 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11030 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11031 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011033ssl_f_serial : binary
11034 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11035 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11036 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011037
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011038ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11039 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11040 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11041 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011043ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11044 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11045 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11046 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048ssl_f_version : integer
11049 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11050 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11051
11052ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011053 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11054 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11055 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057 Example :
11058 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11059 listen http-https
11060 bind :80
11061 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11062 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11063
11064ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11065 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11066 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11067
11068ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011069 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011070 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11071 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11072 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11073 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11074 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11075 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11076 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11077 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011079ssl_fc_cipher : string
11080 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11081 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011084 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11085 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011086 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11087 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11088 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11089 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011091ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11092 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011093 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11094 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11095 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11096 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011098ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011099 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011100 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11101 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11102 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11103 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11104 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11105 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11106 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108ssl_fc_protocol : string
11109 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11110 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011111
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011112ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011113 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011114 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11115 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011117ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11118 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11119 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11120 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11121 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011123ssl_fc_sni : string
11124 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11125 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11126 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11127 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11128 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11129
11130 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11131 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11132 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011133 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11134 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011137 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11138 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011140ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11141 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11142 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011143
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011144
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111457.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011146------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011148Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11149sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11150only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11151For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11152be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11153can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11154sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11155for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11156content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011158payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11159 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11160 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11161 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11164 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11165 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11166 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011168req.len : integer
11169req_len : integer (deprecated)
11170 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11171 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11172 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11173 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11174 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11175 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11176 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11177 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011179req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11180 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011181 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11182 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11183 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11184 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011186 ACL alternatives :
11187 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011189req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11190 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11191 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11192 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11193 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011195 ACL alternatives :
11196 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011198 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011200req.proto_http : boolean
11201req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11202 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11203 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11204 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11205 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11206 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11207 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11208 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011210 Example:
11211 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11212 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11213 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011214 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011216req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11217rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11218 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11219 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11220 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11221 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11222 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11223 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11224 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011226 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11227 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11228 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11229 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11230 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11231 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011233 ACL derivatives :
11234 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011236 Example :
11237 listen tse-farm
11238 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11239 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11240 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11241 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11242 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11243 persist rdp-cookie
11244 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11245 # This is only useful makes sense if
11246 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11247 stick-table type string size 204800
11248 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11249 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11250 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011252 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11253 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011255req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11256rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11257 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11258 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11259 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11260 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011262 ACL derivatives :
11263 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011265req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11266req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11267 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11268 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11269 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11270 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11271 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11272 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11273 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011275req.ssl_sni : string
11276req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11277 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11278 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11279 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11280 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11281 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11282 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11283 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11284 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11285 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11286 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11287 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11288 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290 ACL derivatives :
11291 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011293 Examples :
11294 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11295 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11296 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11297 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11298 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011300res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11301rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11302 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11303 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11304 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11305 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11306 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11307 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11308 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011310req.ssl_ver : integer
11311req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11312 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11313 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11314 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11315 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11316 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11317 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11318 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11319 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11320 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011322 ACL derivatives :
11323 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011324
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011325res.len : integer
11326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11327 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11328 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11329 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11330 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11331 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11332 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11333 content inspection.
11334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11336 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011337 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11338 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11339 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11340 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11343 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11344 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11345 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11346 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011348 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350wait_end : boolean
11351 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11352 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11353 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11354 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11355 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11356 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11357 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11358 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360 Examples :
11361 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11362 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11363 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011365 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11366 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11367 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11368 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11369 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11370 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11371 tcp-request content reject
11372
11373
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113747.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011375--------------------------------------
11376
11377It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11378This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11379data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11380its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11381HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11382content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11383to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11384more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11385response are indexed.
11386
11387base : string
11388 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11389 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11390 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11391 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11392 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11393 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11394 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11395 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11396
11397 ACL derivatives :
11398 base : exact string match
11399 base_beg : prefix match
11400 base_dir : subdir match
11401 base_dom : domain match
11402 base_end : suffix match
11403 base_len : length match
11404 base_reg : regex match
11405 base_sub : substring match
11406
11407base32 : integer
11408 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11409 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11410 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11411 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11412
11413base32+src : binary
11414 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11415 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11416 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11417 per-URL counters.
11418
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011419capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11420 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11421 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11422 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11423
11424capture.req.method : string
11425 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11426 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11427 because it's allocated.
11428
11429capture.req.uri : string
11430 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11431 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11432 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11433 allocated.
11434
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011435capture.req.ver : string
11436 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11437 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11438 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11439
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011440capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11441 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11442 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11443 The first entry is an index of 0.
11444 See also: "capture response header"
11445
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011446capture.res.ver : string
11447 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11448 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11449 persistent flag.
11450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011451req.cook([<name>]) : string
11452cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11453 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11454 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11455 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11456 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11457 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11458 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11459 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11460 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11461
11462 ACL derivatives :
11463 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11464 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11465 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11466 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11467 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11468 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11469 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11470 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011472req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11473cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11474 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11475 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011477req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11478cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11479 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11480 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11481 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11482 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11485 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11486 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11487 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11488 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11489 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11490 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11491 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11492 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11493 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11494 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011496hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11497 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11498 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11499 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11500 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011501 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011503req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11504 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11505 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11506 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11507 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11508 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11509 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11510 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11511 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11514 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11515 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11516 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11517 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011519req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11520 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11521 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11522 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11523 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11524 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11525 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11526 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11527 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11528 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11529 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11530 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011532 ACL derivatives :
11533 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11534 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11535 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11536 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11537 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11538 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11539 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11540 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11541
11542req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11543hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11544 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11545 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11546 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11547 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11548 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11549 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11550 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11551 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11552 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11553
11554req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11555hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11556 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11557 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11558 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11559 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11560 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11561 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11562 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11563 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11564
11565req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11566hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11567 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11568 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11569 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11570 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11571 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11572 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11573 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11574
11575http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11576 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11577 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11578 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11579 basic auth is supported.
11580
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011581http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11582 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11583 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11584 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11585 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011586 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11587 basic auth is supported.
11588
11589 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011590 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11591 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11592 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11593 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594
11595http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011596 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11597 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011598 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11599 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011601method : integer + string
11602 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11603 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11604 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11605 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11606 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11607 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11608 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011610 ACL derivatives :
11611 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613 Example :
11614 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11615 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11616 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011618path : string
11619 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11620 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11621 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11622 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11623 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11624 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11625 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011627 ACL derivatives :
11628 path : exact string match
11629 path_beg : prefix match
11630 path_dir : subdir match
11631 path_dom : domain match
11632 path_end : suffix match
11633 path_len : length match
11634 path_reg : regex match
11635 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011637req.ver : string
11638req_ver : string (deprecated)
11639 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11640 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11641 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011643 ACL derivatives :
11644 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011646res.comp : boolean
11647 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11648 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11649 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651res.comp_algo : string
11652 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11653 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11654 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011656res.cook([<name>]) : string
11657scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11658 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11659 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11660 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011662 ACL derivatives :
11663 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11666scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11667 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11668 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11669 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011671res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11672scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11673 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11674 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11675 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011677res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11678 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11679 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11680 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11681 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11682 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11683 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11684 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11685 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11686 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11689 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11690 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11691 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11692 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11693 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011695res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11696shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11697 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11698 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11699 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11700 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11701 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11702 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11703 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11704 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011706 ACL derivatives :
11707 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11708 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11709 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11710 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11711 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11712 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11713 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11714 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11715
11716res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11717shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11718 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11719 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11720 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11721 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11722 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11725shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11726 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11727 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11728 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11729 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11730 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11731 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011733res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11734shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11735 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11736 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11737 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11738 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11739 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11740 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011742res.ver : string
11743resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11744 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11745 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011747 ACL derivatives :
11748 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11751 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11752 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11753 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11754 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011756 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11757 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011759 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011761status : integer
11762 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11763 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11764 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011766url : string
11767 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11768 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11769 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11770 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11771 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11772 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11773 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011775 ACL derivatives :
11776 url : exact string match
11777 url_beg : prefix match
11778 url_dir : subdir match
11779 url_dom : domain match
11780 url_end : suffix match
11781 url_len : length match
11782 url_reg : regex match
11783 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011785url_ip : ip
11786 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11787 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11788 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11789 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11790 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11791 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11792 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011794url_port : integer
11795 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11796 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11797 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11798 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011800urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11801url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11802 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11803 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11804 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11805 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11806 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11807 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11808 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11809 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11810 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011812 ACL derivatives :
11813 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11814 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11815 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11816 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11817 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11818 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11819 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11820 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011821
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011823 Example :
11824 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11825 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11826 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11827 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011829urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11830 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11831 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11832 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011833
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118357.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011836---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011838Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11839every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011840order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011842ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11843---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011844FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011845HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011846HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11847HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011848HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11849HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11850HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11851HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11852LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011853METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11854METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11855METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11856METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11857METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11858METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011859RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011860REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011861TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011862WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11863---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011864
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118668. Logging
11867----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011868
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011869One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11870provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11871very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11872provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11873state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011874to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011875headers.
11876
11877In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11878about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11879send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11880
11881 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11882 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11883 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11884 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11885 at the termination.
11886
11887The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11888allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11889as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11890while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11891real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11892delay.
11893
11894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118958.1. Log levels
11896---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011897
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011898TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011899source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011900HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11901in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11902track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11903syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11904about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011905
11906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119078.2. Log formats
11908----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011909
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011910HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011911and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11912slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11913options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011914
11915 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11916 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11917 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11918 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11919 extents.
11920
11921 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11922 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11923 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11924 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11925 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11926
11927 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11928 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11929 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11930 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11931 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11932
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011933 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11934 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11935 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11936 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11937
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011938 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11939
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011940Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11941specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11942field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11943servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11944always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11945identifier.
11946
11947Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11948 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11949 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11950 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11951 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11952
11953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119548.2.1. Default log format
11955-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011956
11957This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11958as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11959format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11960
11961 Example :
11962 listen www
11963 mode http
11964 log global
11965 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11966
11967 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11968 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11969 (www/HTTP)
11970
11971 Field Format Extract from the example above
11972 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11973 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11974 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11975 4 'to' to
11976 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11977 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11978
11979Detailed fields description :
11980 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11981 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11982 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11983 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11984 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11985 and processed the connection.
11986 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11987
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011988In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11989"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11990connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11991
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011992It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11993will eventually disappear.
11994
11995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119968.2.2. TCP log format
11997---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011998
11999The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12000is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12001information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12002counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12003emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12004environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12005the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12006sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012007specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12008not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12009fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12010marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012011
12012 Example :
12013 frontend fnt
12014 mode tcp
12015 option tcplog
12016 log global
12017 default_backend bck
12018
12019 backend bck
12020 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12021
12022 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12023 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12024 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12025
12026 Field Format Extract from the example above
12027 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12028 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12029 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12030 4 frontend_name fnt
12031 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12032 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12033 7 bytes_read* 212
12034 8 termination_state --
12035 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12036 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12037
12038Detailed fields description :
12039 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012040 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12041 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12042 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12043 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12044 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012045
12046 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012047 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12048 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12049 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012050
12051 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12052 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12053 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12054 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12055
12056 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12057 and processed the connection.
12058
12059 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12060 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12061 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12062 applications.
12063
12064 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12065 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12066 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12067 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12068 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12069
12070 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12071 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12072 See "Timers" below for more details.
12073
12074 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12075 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12076 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12077 "Timers" below for more details.
12078
12079 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012080 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012081 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12082 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12083 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12084 details.
12085
12086 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12087 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12088 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12089 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12090 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12091
12092 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12093 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12094 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12095 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12096 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12097 for more details.
12098
12099 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012100 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012101 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12102 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12103 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012104 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012105
12106 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12107 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12108 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12109 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12110 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12111 caused by a denial of service attack.
12112
12113 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12114 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12115 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12116 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12117 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12118 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12119 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12120 denial of service attack.
12121
12122 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12123 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12124 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12125 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12126 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12127 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12128 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12129 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12130 be processed than on other servers.
12131
12132 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12133 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12134 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12135 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12136 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12137 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12138 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12139 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12140 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12141 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12142 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12143 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12144 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12145
12146 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12147 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12148 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12149 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12150 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12151 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12152 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12153 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12154
12155 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12156 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12157 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12158 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12159 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12160 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12161 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12162 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12163 occurs.
12164
12165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121668.2.3. HTTP log format
12167----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012168
12169The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12170is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12171the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12172are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12173emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12174generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12175"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12176which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012177frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12178is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012179
12180Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12181slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12182with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12183
12184 Example :
12185 frontend http-in
12186 mode http
12187 option httplog
12188 log global
12189 default_backend bck
12190
12191 backend static
12192 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12193
12194 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12195 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12196 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012197 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012198
12199 Field Format Extract from the example above
12200 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12201 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12202 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12203 4 frontend_name http-in
12204 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12205 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12206 7 status_code 200
12207 8 bytes_read* 2750
12208 9 captured_request_cookie -
12209 10 captured_response_cookie -
12210 11 termination_state ----
12211 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12212 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12213 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12214 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12215 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012216
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012217
12218Detailed fields description :
12219 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012220 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12221 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12222 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12223 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12224 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012225
12226 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012227 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12228 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12229 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012230
12231 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12232 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12233 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12234 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12235 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12236
12237 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12238 and processed the connection.
12239
12240 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12241 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12242 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12243
12244 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12245 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12246 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12247 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12248 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12249 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12250
12251 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12252 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12253 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12254 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12255 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12256 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12257
12258 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12259 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12260 See "Timers" below for more details.
12261
12262 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12263 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12264 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12265 below for more details.
12266
12267 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12268 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12269 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12270 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12271 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12272 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12273 for more details.
12274
12275 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012276 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012277 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12278 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12279 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12280 details.
12281
12282 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12283 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12284 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12285
12286 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12287 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12288 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12289 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12290 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12291 overflowing.
12292
12293 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12294 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12295 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12296 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12297 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12298 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12299 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12300 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12301
12302 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12303 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12304 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12305 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12306 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12307 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12308 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12309 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12310
12311 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12312 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12313 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12314 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12315 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12316 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12317 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12318
12319 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012320 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012321 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12322 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12323 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012324 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012325 system.
12326
12327 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12328 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12329 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12330 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12331 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12332 caused by a denial of service attack.
12333
12334 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12335 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12336 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12337 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12338 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12339 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12340 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12341 denial of service attack.
12342
12343 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12344 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12345 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12346 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12347 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12348 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12349 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12350 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12351 processed than on other servers.
12352
12353 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12354 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12355 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12356 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12357 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12358 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12359 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12360 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12361 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12362 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12363 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12364 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12365 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12366
12367 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12368 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12369 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12370 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12371 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12372 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12373 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12374 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12375
12376 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12377 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12378 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12379 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12380 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12381 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12382 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12383 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12384 occurs.
12385
12386 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12387 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12388 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12389 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12390 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12391 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12392 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12393 cookies" below for more details.
12394
12395 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12396 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12397 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12398 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12399 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12400 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12401 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12402 and cookies" below for more details.
12403
12404 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12405 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12406 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12407 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12408 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12409 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12410 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12411 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12412
12413
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200124148.2.4. Custom log format
12415------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012416
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012417The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012418mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012419
12420HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12421Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12422separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12423prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12424
12425Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12426variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12427string formats ("Q").
12428
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012429If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012430as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012431less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12432the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12433
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012434Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012435In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012436in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012437
12438Flags are :
12439 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012440 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012441
12442 Example:
12443
12444 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12445 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12446
12447At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12448
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012449 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12450 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012451
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012452the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012453
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012454 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012455 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012456 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012457
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012458and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12459
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012460 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012461 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12462
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012463Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12464
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012465 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012466 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012467 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12468 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12469 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012470 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12471 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12472 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012473 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012474 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012475 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012476 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012477 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012478 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012479 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12480 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012481 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012482 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12483 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012484 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012485 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12486 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012487 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12488 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12489 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012490 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012491 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12492 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012493 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012494 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12495 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12496 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012497 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012498 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12499 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12500 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12501 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012502 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012503 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012504 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012505 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012506 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012507 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012508 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12509 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12510 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012511 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012512 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12513 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012514 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012515 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012516 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012517 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012518
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012519 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012520
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012521
125228.2.5. Error log format
12523-----------------------
12524
12525When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12526protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12527By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12528"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12529will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12530logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12531
12532The format looks like this :
12533
12534 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12535 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12536 Connection error during SSL handshake
12537
12538 Field Format Extract from the example above
12539 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12540 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12541 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12542 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12543 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12544
12545These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12546failures.
12547
12548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125498.3. Advanced logging options
12550-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012551
12552Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12553just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12554options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12555for more information about their usage.
12556
12557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125588.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12559------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012560
12561It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12562haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12563commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12564monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12565ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12566
12567 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12568 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12569 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12570 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12571
12572 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12573 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12574 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012575 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012576 such as other load-balancers.
12577
12578 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12579 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12580 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12581
12582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125838.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12584----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012585
12586The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12587what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12588or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12589"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12590just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12591log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12592after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12593is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12594with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12595with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12596
12597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12599------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012600
12601Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12602for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12603"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12604retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12605raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12606a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12607file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12608you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12609"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12610
12611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126128.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12613--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012614
12615Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12616multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12617them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12618"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12619logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12620error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12621and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12622too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12623useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12624alternative.
12625
12626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126278.4. Timing events
12628------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012629
12630Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12631reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12632the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12633frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12634mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12635
12636 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12637 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12638 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12639 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12640 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12641
12642 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12643 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12644 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12645 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12646 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12647
12648 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12649 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12650 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12651 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12652 connection never established.
12653
12654 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12655 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12656 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12657 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12658 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12659 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12660 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12661 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12662 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12663 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12664 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12665
12666 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12667 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12668 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12669 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012670 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012671
12672 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12673
12674 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12675 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12676 negative.
12677
12678These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12679protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12680that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012681due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012682close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12683session has been aborted on timeout.
12684
12685Most common cases :
12686
12687 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12688 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12689 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12690 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12691 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12692 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12693 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12694 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12695 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012696 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12697 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12698 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012699
12700 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12701 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12702 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12703 of ms on remote networks.
12704
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012705 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12706 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12707 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012708
12709 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12710 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12711 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12712 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12713 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12714 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12715 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12716 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12717 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12718 to the server until another one is released.
12719
12720Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12721
12722 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12723 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12724 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12725
12726 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12727 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12728 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12729
12730 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12731 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12732 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12733 flags.
12734
12735 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12736 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12737 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12738 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12739 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12740 the client connection was maintained open.
12741
12742 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012743 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012744 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12745 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12746
12747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127488.5. Session state at disconnection
12749-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012750
12751TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12752"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
127532-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12754each of which has a special meaning :
12755
12756 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12757 session to terminate :
12758
12759 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12760
12761 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12762 server explicitly refused it.
12763
12764 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12765 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12766 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12767 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012768 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12769
12770 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12771 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012772
12773 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12774 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12775 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12776 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12777 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12778
12779 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12780 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12781 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12782 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12783 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12784
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012785 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12786 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12787
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012788 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12789 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12790 backup connections when going up.
12791
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012792 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12793
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012794 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12795 send or receive data.
12796
12797 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12798 send or receive data.
12799
12800 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12801 with nothing left in the buffers.
12802
12803 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12804
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012805 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012806 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12807
12808 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12809 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12810 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12811 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12812 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12813
12814 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12815 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12816
12817 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12818 server (HTTP only).
12819
12820 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12821
12822 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12823 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12824 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12825
12826 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12827 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12828 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12829
12830 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12831
12832 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12833 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12834
12835 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12836 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12837 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12838
12839 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12840 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012841 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12842 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012843
12844 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12845 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12846 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12847 another server.
12848
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012849 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012850 server.
12851
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012852 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12853 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12854 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12855 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12856
12857 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12858 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12859 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12860 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12861
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012862 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12863 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12864 "use-server" rule).
12865
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012866 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12867
12868 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12869 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12870
12871 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12872
12873 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12874 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12875 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12876
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012877 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12878 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012879 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012880 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12881 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12882
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012883 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12884
12885 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12886 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12887
12888 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12889
12890 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12891
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012892The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12893was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012894helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12895starvation, attacks, etc...
12896
12897The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12898alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12899easier finding and understanding.
12900
12901 Flags Reason
12902
12903 -- Normal termination.
12904
12905 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12906 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12907 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12908 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12909
12910 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12911 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12912 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12913 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12914 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12915 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012916
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012917 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12918 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012919 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012920
12921 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12922 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12923 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12924
12925 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12926 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12927 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12928 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12929 the server takes too long to respond.
12930
12931 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12932 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12933 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12934 long a time to respond.
12935
12936 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12937 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12938 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12939 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12940 and the client.
12941
12942 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12943 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12944 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12945 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12946 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012947 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12948 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12949 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12950 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12951 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12952 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12953 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12954 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12955 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12956 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12957 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12958 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12959 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12960 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012961
12962 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12963 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012964 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12965 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12966 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12967 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012968
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012969 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12970 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012972 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012973 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12974 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12975 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12976 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12977 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12978
12979 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12980 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12981 503 or 504 here.
12982
12983 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12984 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12985 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12986 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12987 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12988
12989 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12990 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012991 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012992 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12993 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12994
12995 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12996 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12997 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12998 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12999 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13000 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13001 between haproxy and the server.
13002
13003 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13004 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13005 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13006 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13007 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13008 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13009 solution is to fix the application.
13010
13011 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13012 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13013 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13014 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13015 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13016 external attacks.
13017
13018 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13019 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013020 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013021 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13022 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13023
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013024 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13025 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13026 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013027 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13028 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013029
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013030 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13031 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13032 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13033 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013034 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13035 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13036 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13037 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13038 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013039
13040 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13041 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13042 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13043 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13044
13045 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13046 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13047 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13048 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13049
13050 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13051 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13052 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13053 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13054
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013055The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13056persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13057important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13058re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13059
13060 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13061
13062 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13063 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13064 set on a GET request.
13065
13066 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13067 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013068 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013069 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13070
13071 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13072 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13073 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13074
13075 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13076 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13077 already got a cookie.
13078
13079 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13080 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13081 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13082 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13083 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13084
13085 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13086 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13087 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13088
13089 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13090 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13091 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13092
13093 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13094 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13095
13096 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13097 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13098 then advertised in the response.
13099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131018.6. Non-printable characters
13102-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013103
13104In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13105consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13106converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13107prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13108being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13109escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13110is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13111'}' when logging headers.
13112
13113Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13114issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13115containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13116
13117Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13118the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13119performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13120
13121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131228.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13123---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013124
13125Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13126achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013127section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013128cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13129the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13130the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013131locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013132not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13133user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13134a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13135wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13136
13137 Examples :
13138 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13139 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13140
13141 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13142 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13143
13144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131458.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13146---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013147
13148Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13149proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13150the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13151server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13152
13153Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13154response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013155section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013156
13157It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013158time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13159appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013160are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13161and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13162follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13163request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13164in the logs.
13165
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013166As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13167frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13168an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13169
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013170 Example :
13171 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13172 listen proxy-out
13173 mode http
13174 option httplog
13175 option logasap
13176 log global
13177 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13178
13179 # log the name of the virtual server
13180 capture request header Host len 20
13181
13182 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13183 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13184
13185 # log the beginning of the referrer
13186 capture request header Referer len 20
13187
13188 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13189 capture response header Server len 20
13190
13191 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13192 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13193
13194 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13195 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13196
13197 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13198 capture response header Via len 20
13199
13200 # log the URL location during a redirection
13201 capture response header Location len 20
13202
13203 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13204 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13205 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13206 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13207 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13208
13209 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13210 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13211 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13212 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013213 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013214
13215 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13216 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13217 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13218 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13219 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013220 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013221
13222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132238.9. Examples of logs
13224---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013225
13226These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13227them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13228reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13229
13230 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13231 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13232 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13233
13234 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13235 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13236
13237 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13238 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13239 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13240
13241 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13242 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13243
13244 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13245 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13246 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13247
13248 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013249 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013250 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13251 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13252
13253 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13254 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13255 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13256
13257 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13258 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013259 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013260 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13261 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13262 to return the 502 and not the server.
13263
13264 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013265 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013266
13267 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13268 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13269 Nothing was sent to any server.
13270
13271 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13272 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13273
13274 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13275 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13276 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13277 send a 408 return code to the client.
13278
13279 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13280 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13281
13282 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13283 5 seconds ("c----").
13284
13285 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13286 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013287 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013288
13289 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013290 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013291 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13292 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13293 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13294 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13295 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013296
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132989. Statistics and monitoring
13299----------------------------
13300
13301It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13302mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13303CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13304Unix socket.
13305
13306
133079.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013308---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013309
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013310The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013311page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13312begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13313represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13314use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13315('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13316(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13317text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13318do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13319use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013320
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013321In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13322that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13323S (Servers).
13324
13325 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13326 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13327 any name for server/listener)
13328 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13329 number queued without a server assigned.
13330 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13331 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13332 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13333 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13334 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13335 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13336 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13337 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13338 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13339 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13340 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13341 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13342 "option checkcache".
13343 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13344 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13345 - read error from the client
13346 - client timeout
13347 - client closed connection
13348 - various bad requests from the client.
13349 - request was tarpitted.
13350 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13351 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13352 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13353 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13354 active servers).
13355 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13356 Some other errors are:
13357 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13358 - failure applying filters to the response.
13359 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13360 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13361 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13362 switched away from.
13363 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13364 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13365 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13366 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13367 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13368 the server is up.)
13369 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13370 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13371 counters for each server.
13372 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13373 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13374 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13375 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13376 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13377 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13378 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13379 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13380 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13381 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13382 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13383 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13384 of times that server was selected.
13385 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13386 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13387 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13388 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13389 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13390 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013391 UNK -> unknown
13392 INI -> initializing
13393 SOCKERR -> socket error
13394 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13395 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13396 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13397 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13398 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13399 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13400 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13401 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13402 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13403 disable-on-404
13404 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13405 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13406 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013407 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13408 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13409 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13410 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13411 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13412 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13413 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13414 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13415 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13416 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13417 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13418 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13419 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13420 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13421 (inc. in eresp)
13422 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13423 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13424 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13425 (CPU/BW limit)
13426 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13427 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13428 server/backend
13429 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13430 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13431 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13432 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13433 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13434 (0 for TCP)
13435 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13436 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013437
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134399.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013440-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013441
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013442The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13443necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13444A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13445issuing commands by hand :
13446
13447 global
13448 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13449 stats timeout 2m
13450
13451It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13452the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13453never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13454situations :
13455
13456 global
13457 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13458 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13459 stats timeout 2m
13460
13461To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13462swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13463to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13464syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13465
13466 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13467 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13468
13469The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13470script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13471for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13472
13473The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13474that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13475editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13476(eg: watch a counter).
13477
13478The socket supports two operation modes :
13479 - interactive
13480 - non-interactive
13481
13482The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13483this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13484sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13485mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13486commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13487example :
13488
13489 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13490
13491The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13492entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13493for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13494sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13495"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13496after processing the last command of the same line.
13497
13498For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13499"prompt" command :
13500
13501 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13502 prompt
13503 > show info
13504 ...
13505 >
13506
13507Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13508delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13509that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13510parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013511
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013512It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13513on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13514own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013515
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013516The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13517If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13518all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13519it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13520
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013521add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013522 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13523 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13524 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13525 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013526
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013527add map <map> <key> <value>
13528 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13529 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013530 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13531 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13532 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013533
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013534clear counters
13535 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13536 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13537 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13538 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13539 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13540
13541clear counters all
13542 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13543 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13544 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13545
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013546clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013547 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13548 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13549 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013550
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013551clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013552 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13553 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13554 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013555
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013556clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13557 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13558
13559 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13560 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13561 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13562 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13563 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13564 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13565
13566 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13567
13568 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13569 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13570 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13571 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13572 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13573 the ACLs :
13574
13575 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13576 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13577 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13578 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13579 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13580 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13581
13582 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013583 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13584 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013585
13586 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013587 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013588 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013589 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13590 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13591 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13592 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013593
13594 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13595
13596 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013597 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013598 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13599 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013600 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13601 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13602 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013603
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013604del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13605 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013606 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13607 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13608 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13609 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013610
13611del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013612 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013613 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13614 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13615 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13616 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013617
13618disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013619 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13620
13621 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13622 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13623 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13624 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13625 re-enabled using enable agent.
13626
13627 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13628 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13629 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13630 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13631 otherwise unchanged.
13632
13633 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13634 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13635 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13636
13637 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13638 level "admin".
13639
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013640disable frontend <frontend>
13641 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13642 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13643 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13644 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13645 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13646 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13647 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13648 on the stats page.
13649
13650 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13651 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13652
13653 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13654 level "admin".
13655
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013656disable health <backend>/<server>
13657 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13658 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13659 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13660 agent check forces it down.
13661
13662 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13663 level "admin".
13664
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013665disable server <backend>/<server>
13666 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13667 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13668 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13669 during the maintenance.
13670
13671 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13672 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13673
13674 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013675 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013676
13677 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13678 level "admin".
13679
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013680enable agent <backend>/<server>
13681 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13682
13683 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13684 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13685
13686 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13687 level "admin".
13688
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013689enable frontend <frontend>
13690 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13691 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13692 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13693 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13694 which was disabled.
13695
13696 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13697 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13698
13699 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13700 level "admin".
13701
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013702enable health <backend>/<server>
13703 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13704 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13705
13706 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13707 level "admin".
13708
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013709enable server <backend>/<server>
13710 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13711 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13712
13713 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013714 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013715
13716 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13717 level "admin".
13718
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013719get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013720get acl <acl> <value>
13721 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13722 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13723 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13724 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13725 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013726
13727 The first two words are:
13728
13729 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13730 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13731 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13732
13733 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13734
13735 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13736
13737 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13738
13739 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13740 interpretation of the case.
13741
13742 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13743 useful with regular expressions.
13744
13745 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13746 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13747
13748 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13749 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13750 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13751
13752 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13753
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013754get weight <backend>/<server>
13755 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13756 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13757 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13758 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13759 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013760 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013761
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013762help
13763 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13764 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013765
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013766prompt
13767 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13768 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13769 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13770 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13771 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13772 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13773 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13774 command.
13775
13776quit
13777 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013778
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013779set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013780 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13781 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13782 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013783
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013784set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013785 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13786 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13787 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13788 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13789 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013790 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13791 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13792
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013793set maxconn global <maxconn>
13794 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13795 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13796 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13797 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13798 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13799 setting.
13800
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013801set rate-limit connections global <value>
13802 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13803 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13804 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13805 is passed in number of connections per second.
13806
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013807set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13808 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13809 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013810 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13811 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013812
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013813set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13814 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13815 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13816 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13817 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13818
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013819set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13820 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13821 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13822 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13823 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13824 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13825
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013826set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13827 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13828 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13829 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13830
13831set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13832 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13833 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13834 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13835
13836set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13837 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13838 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13839 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13840 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13841 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13842 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13843 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13844 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13845
13846set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13847 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13848 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13849
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013850set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13851 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13852 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13853 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13854 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13855
13856 Example:
13857 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13858 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13859 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13860 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13861
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013862set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013863 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13864 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13865 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13866 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013867 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13868 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013869
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013870set timeout cli <delay>
13871 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13872 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13873 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13874
13875set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13876 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13877 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013878 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13879 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13880 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13881 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13882 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13883 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13884 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13885 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13886 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13887 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13888 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13889 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13890 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013891
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013892show errors [<iid>]
13893 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13894 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013895 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13896 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13897 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013898
13899 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13900 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13901 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13902 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13903 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13904 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13905 are reported too.
13906
13907 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13908 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13909 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13910 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13911 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13912 code.
13913
13914 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13915 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13916 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13917 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13918 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13919 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13920 line.
13921
13922 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013923 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13924 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013925 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13926 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13927
13928 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13929 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13930 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13931 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13932 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13933 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13934 00204+ minal\r\n
13935 00211 \r\n
13936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013937 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013938 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13939 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13940 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13941 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13942 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13943 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013944
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013945show info
13946 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13947
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013948show map [<map>]
13949 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013950 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13951 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13952 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13953 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13954 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13955 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013956
13957show acl [<acl>]
13958 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013959 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13960 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13961 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13962 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13963 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013964
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013965show pools
13966 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13967 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13968 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13969 the pools.
13970
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013971show sess
13972 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013973 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13974 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13975
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013976show sess <id>
13977 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13978 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13979 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13980 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13981 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013982 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13983 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13984 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013985
13986show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13987 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13988 possible to dump only selected items :
13989 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13990 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13991 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13992 for example:
13993 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13994 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13995 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13996
13997 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013998 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13999 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014000 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14001 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14002 Nbproc: 1
14003 Process_num: 1
14004 (...)
14005
14006 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14007 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14008 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14009 (...)
14010 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14011
14012 $
14013
14014 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14015 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14016 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14017 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014018 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014019
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014020show table
14021 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14022 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14023 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14024 entries currently in use.
14025
14026 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014027 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014028 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14029 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014030
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014031show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014032 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14033 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14034 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014035 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14036
14037 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14038 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14039 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14040 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14041 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14042
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014043 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14044 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14045 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14046 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14047 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14048 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14049
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014050
14051 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014052 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14053 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014054
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014055 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014056 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014057 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014058 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14059 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14060 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14061 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014062
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014063 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014064 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014065 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14066 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014067
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014068 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14069 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014070 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014071 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14072 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014073
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014074 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14075 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014076 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014077 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14078 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14079
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014080 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14081 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14082 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14083 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14084 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14085
14086 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14087 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14088 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014089 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14090 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014091 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14092 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014093
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014094shutdown frontend <frontend>
14095 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14096 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14097 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14098 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14099 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14100 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14101 once it is terminated.
14102
14103 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14104 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14105
14106 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14107 level "admin".
14108
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014109shutdown session <id>
14110 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14111 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14112 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14113 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14114 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14115 flag in the logs.
14116
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014117shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014118 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14119 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14120 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14121 'K' flag in the logs.
14122
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014123/*
14124 * Local variables:
14125 * fill-column: 79
14126 * End:
14127 */